1 /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 // Name: src/richtext/richtextbuffer.cpp
3 // Purpose: Buffer for wxRichTextCtrl
4 // Author: Julian Smart
8 // Copyright: (c) Julian Smart
9 // Licence: wxWindows licence
10 /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12 // For compilers that support precompilation, includes "wx.h".
13 #include "wx/wxprec.h"
21 #include "wx/richtext/richtextbuffer.h"
27 #include "wx/dataobj.h"
28 #include "wx/module.h"
31 #include "wx/settings.h"
32 #include "wx/filename.h"
33 #include "wx/clipbrd.h"
34 #include "wx/wfstream.h"
35 #include "wx/mstream.h"
36 #include "wx/sstream.h"
37 #include "wx/textfile.h"
38 #include "wx/hashmap.h"
39 #include "wx/dynarray.h"
41 #include "wx/richtext/richtextctrl.h"
42 #include "wx/richtext/richtextstyles.h"
43 #include "wx/richtext/richtextimagedlg.h"
44 #include "wx/richtext/richtextsizepage.h"
46 #include "wx/listimpl.cpp"
47 #include "wx/arrimpl.cpp"
49 WX_DEFINE_LIST(wxRichTextObjectList
)
50 WX_DEFINE_LIST(wxRichTextLineList
)
52 // Switch off if the platform doesn't like it for some reason
53 #define wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING 1
55 // Use GetPartialTextExtents for platforms that support it natively
56 #define wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS 1
58 const wxChar wxRichTextLineBreakChar
= (wxChar
) 29;
60 // Helper classes for floating layout
61 struct wxRichTextFloatRectMap
63 wxRichTextFloatRectMap(int sY
, int eY
, int w
, wxRichTextObject
* obj
)
73 wxRichTextObject
* anchor
;
76 WX_DEFINE_SORTED_ARRAY(wxRichTextFloatRectMap
*, wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
);
78 int wxRichTextFloatRectMapCmp(wxRichTextFloatRectMap
* r1
, wxRichTextFloatRectMap
* r2
)
80 return r1
->startY
- r2
->startY
;
83 class wxRichTextFloatCollector
86 wxRichTextFloatCollector(const wxRect
& availableRect
);
87 ~wxRichTextFloatCollector();
89 // Collect the floating objects info in the given paragraph
90 void CollectFloat(wxRichTextParagraph
* para
);
91 void CollectFloat(wxRichTextParagraph
* para
, wxRichTextObject
* floating
);
93 // Return the last paragraph we collected
94 wxRichTextParagraph
* LastParagraph();
96 // Given the start y position and the height of the line,
97 // find out how wide the line can be
98 wxRect
GetAvailableRect(int startY
, int endY
);
100 // Given a floating box, find its fit position
101 int GetFitPosition(int direction
, int start
, int height
) const;
102 int GetFitPosition(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, int start
, int height
) const;
104 // Find the last y position
105 int GetLastRectBottom();
107 // Draw the floats inside a rect
108 void Draw(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
);
110 // HitTest the floats
111 int HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, int flags
);
113 // Get floating object count
114 int GetFloatingObjectCount() const { return m_left
.GetCount() + m_right
.GetCount(); }
116 // Get floating objects
117 bool GetFloatingObjects(wxRichTextObjectList
& objects
) const;
120 bool DeleteFloat(wxRichTextObject
* obj
);
122 // Do we have this float already?
123 bool HasFloat(wxRichTextObject
* obj
);
125 bool HasFloats() const { return m_left
.GetCount() >0 || m_right
.GetCount() > 0; }
127 static int SearchAdjacentRect(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, int point
);
129 static int GetWidthFromFloatRect(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, int index
, int startY
, int endY
);
131 static void FreeFloatRectMapArray(wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
);
133 static void DrawFloat(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
);
135 static int HitTestFloat(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, wxDC
& WXUNUSED(dc
), const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, int flags
);
138 wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray m_left
;
139 wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray m_right
;
141 wxRect m_availableRect
;
142 wxRichTextParagraph
* m_para
;
146 bool wxRichTextFloatCollector::DeleteFloat(wxRichTextObject
* obj
)
149 for (i
= 0; i
< m_left
.GetCount(); i
++)
151 if (m_left
[i
]->anchor
== obj
)
157 for (i
= 0; i
< m_right
.GetCount(); i
++)
159 if (m_right
[i
]->anchor
== obj
)
168 // Do we have this float already?
169 bool wxRichTextFloatCollector::HasFloat(wxRichTextObject
* obj
)
172 for (i
= 0; i
< m_left
.GetCount(); i
++)
174 if (m_left
[i
]->anchor
== obj
)
179 for (i
= 0; i
< m_right
.GetCount(); i
++)
181 if (m_right
[i
]->anchor
== obj
)
189 // Get floating objects
190 bool wxRichTextFloatCollector::GetFloatingObjects(wxRichTextObjectList
& objects
) const
193 for (i
= 0; i
< m_left
.GetCount(); i
++)
194 objects
.Append(m_left
[i
]->anchor
);
195 for (i
= 0; i
< m_right
.GetCount(); i
++)
196 objects
.Append(m_right
[i
]->anchor
);
202 * Binary search helper function
203 * The argument point is the Y coordinate, and this fuction
204 * always return the floating rect that contain this coordinate
205 * or under this coordinate.
207 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::SearchAdjacentRect(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, int point
)
209 int end
= array
.GetCount() - 1;
222 int mid
= (start
+ end
) / 2;
223 if (array
[mid
]->startY
<= point
&& array
[mid
]->endY
>= point
)
225 else if (array
[mid
]->startY
> point
)
230 else if (array
[mid
]->endY
< point
)
240 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::GetWidthFromFloatRect(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, int index
, int startY
, int endY
)
243 int len
= array
.GetCount();
245 wxASSERT(index
>= 0 && index
< len
);
247 if (array
[index
]->startY
< startY
&& array
[index
]->endY
> startY
)
248 ret
= ret
< array
[index
]->width
? array
[index
]->width
: ret
;
249 while (index
< len
&& array
[index
]->startY
<= endY
)
251 ret
= ret
< array
[index
]->width
? array
[index
]->width
: ret
;
258 wxRichTextFloatCollector::wxRichTextFloatCollector(const wxRect
& rect
) : m_left(wxRichTextFloatRectMapCmp
), m_right(wxRichTextFloatRectMapCmp
)
260 m_availableRect
= rect
;
264 void wxRichTextFloatCollector::FreeFloatRectMapArray(wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
)
266 int len
= array
.GetCount();
267 for (int i
= 0; i
< len
; i
++)
271 wxRichTextFloatCollector::~wxRichTextFloatCollector()
273 FreeFloatRectMapArray(m_left
);
274 FreeFloatRectMapArray(m_right
);
277 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::GetFitPosition(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, int start
, int height
) const
279 if (array
.GetCount() == 0)
282 int i
= SearchAdjacentRect(array
, start
);
284 while (i
< (int) array
.GetCount())
286 if (array
[i
]->startY
- last
>= height
)
288 last
= array
[i
]->endY
;
295 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::GetFitPosition(int direction
, int start
, int height
) const
297 if (direction
== wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_LEFT
)
298 return GetFitPosition(m_left
, start
, height
);
299 else if (direction
== wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_RIGHT
)
300 return GetFitPosition(m_right
, start
, height
);
303 wxASSERT("Never should be here");
308 // Adds a floating image to the float collector.
309 // The actual positioning is done by wxRichTextParagraph::LayoutFloat.
310 void wxRichTextFloatCollector::CollectFloat(wxRichTextParagraph
* para
, wxRichTextObject
* floating
)
312 int direction
= floating
->GetFloatDirection();
314 wxPoint pos
= floating
->GetPosition();
315 wxSize size
= floating
->GetCachedSize();
316 wxRichTextFloatRectMap
*map
= new wxRichTextFloatRectMap(pos
.y
, pos
.y
+ size
.y
, size
.x
, floating
);
319 case wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_NONE
:
322 case wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_LEFT
:
323 // Just a not-enough simple assertion
324 wxASSERT (m_left
.Index(map
) == wxNOT_FOUND
);
327 case wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_RIGHT
:
328 wxASSERT (m_right
.Index(map
) == wxNOT_FOUND
);
333 wxASSERT("Unrecognised float attribute.");
339 void wxRichTextFloatCollector::CollectFloat(wxRichTextParagraph
* para
)
341 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= para
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
344 wxRichTextObject
* floating
= node
->GetData();
346 if (floating
->IsFloating())
348 CollectFloat(para
, floating
);
351 node
= node
->GetNext();
357 wxRichTextParagraph
* wxRichTextFloatCollector::LastParagraph()
362 wxRect
wxRichTextFloatCollector::GetAvailableRect(int startY
, int endY
)
364 int widthLeft
= 0, widthRight
= 0;
365 if (m_left
.GetCount() != 0)
367 int i
= SearchAdjacentRect(m_left
, startY
);
368 if (i
< (int) m_left
.GetCount())
369 widthLeft
= GetWidthFromFloatRect(m_left
, i
, startY
, endY
);
371 if (m_right
.GetCount() != 0)
373 int j
= SearchAdjacentRect(m_right
, startY
);
374 if (j
< (int) m_right
.GetCount())
375 widthRight
= GetWidthFromFloatRect(m_right
, j
, startY
, endY
);
378 // TODO: actually we want to use the actual image positions to find the
379 // available remaining space, since the image might not be right up against
380 // the left or right edge of the container.
381 return wxRect(widthLeft
+ m_availableRect
.x
, 0, m_availableRect
.width
- widthLeft
- widthRight
, 0);
384 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::GetLastRectBottom()
387 int len
= m_left
.GetCount();
389 ret
= ret
> m_left
[len
-1]->endY
? ret
: m_left
[len
-1]->endY
;
391 len
= m_right
.GetCount();
393 ret
= ret
> m_right
[len
-1]->endY
? ret
: m_right
[len
-1]->endY
;
399 void wxRichTextFloatCollector::DrawFloat(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextRange
& WXUNUSED(range
), const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
402 int end
= rect
.y
+ rect
.height
;
404 i
= SearchAdjacentRect(array
, start
);
405 if (i
< 0 || i
>= (int) array
.GetCount())
407 j
= SearchAdjacentRect(array
, end
);
408 if (j
< 0 || j
>= (int) array
.GetCount())
409 j
= array
.GetCount() - 1;
412 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= array
[i
]->anchor
;
413 wxRichTextRange r
= obj
->GetRange();
414 obj
->Draw(dc
, r
, selection
, wxRect(obj
->GetPosition(), obj
->GetCachedSize()), descent
, style
);
419 void wxRichTextFloatCollector::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
421 if (m_left
.GetCount() > 0)
422 DrawFloat(m_left
, dc
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
423 if (m_right
.GetCount() > 0)
424 DrawFloat(m_right
, dc
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
427 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::HitTestFloat(const wxRichTextFloatRectMapArray
& array
, wxDC
& WXUNUSED(dc
), const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, int WXUNUSED(flags
))
430 if (array
.GetCount() == 0)
431 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
432 i
= SearchAdjacentRect(array
, pt
.y
);
433 if (i
< 0 || i
>= (int) array
.GetCount())
434 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
435 if (!array
[i
]->anchor
->IsShown())
436 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
438 wxPoint point
= array
[i
]->anchor
->GetPosition();
439 wxSize size
= array
[i
]->anchor
->GetCachedSize();
440 if (point
.x
<= pt
.x
&& point
.x
+ size
.x
>= pt
.x
441 && point
.y
<= pt
.y
&& point
.y
+ size
.y
>= pt
.y
)
443 textPosition
= array
[i
]->anchor
->GetRange().GetStart();
444 * obj
= array
[i
]->anchor
;
445 if (pt
.x
> (pt
.x
+ pt
.x
+ size
.x
) / 2)
446 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_BEFORE
;
448 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_AFTER
;
451 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
454 int wxRichTextFloatCollector::HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, int flags
)
456 int ret
= HitTestFloat(m_left
, dc
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, flags
);
457 if (ret
== wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
459 ret
= HitTestFloat(m_right
, dc
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, flags
);
464 // Helpers for efficiency
465 inline void wxCheckSetFont(wxDC
& dc
, const wxFont
& font
)
467 // JACS: did I do this some time ago when testing? Should we re-enable it?
469 const wxFont
& font1
= dc
.GetFont();
470 if (font1
.IsOk() && font
.IsOk())
472 if (font1
.GetPointSize() == font
.GetPointSize() &&
473 font1
.GetFamily() == font
.GetFamily() &&
474 font1
.GetStyle() == font
.GetStyle() &&
475 font1
.GetWeight() == font
.GetWeight() &&
476 font1
.GetUnderlined() == font
.GetUnderlined() &&
477 font1
.GetFamily() == font
.GetFamily() &&
478 font1
.GetFaceName() == font
.GetFaceName())
485 inline void wxCheckSetPen(wxDC
& dc
, const wxPen
& pen
)
487 const wxPen
& pen1
= dc
.GetPen();
488 if (pen1
.IsOk() && pen
.IsOk())
490 if (pen1
.GetWidth() == pen
.GetWidth() &&
491 pen1
.GetStyle() == pen
.GetStyle() &&
492 pen1
.GetColour() == pen
.GetColour())
498 inline void wxCheckSetBrush(wxDC
& dc
, const wxBrush
& brush
)
500 const wxBrush
& brush1
= dc
.GetBrush();
501 if (brush1
.IsOk() && brush
.IsOk())
503 if (brush1
.GetStyle() == brush
.GetStyle() &&
504 brush1
.GetColour() == brush
.GetColour())
512 * This is the base for drawable objects.
515 IMPLEMENT_CLASS(wxRichTextObject
, wxObject
)
517 wxRichTextObject::wxRichTextObject(wxRichTextObject
* parent
)
525 wxRichTextObject::~wxRichTextObject()
529 void wxRichTextObject::Dereference()
537 void wxRichTextObject::Copy(const wxRichTextObject
& obj
)
540 m_maxSize
= obj
.m_maxSize
;
541 m_minSize
= obj
.m_minSize
;
543 m_range
= obj
.m_range
;
544 m_ownRange
= obj
.m_ownRange
;
545 m_attributes
= obj
.m_attributes
;
546 m_properties
= obj
.m_properties
;
547 m_descent
= obj
.m_descent
;
551 // Get/set the top-level container of this object.
552 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* wxRichTextObject::GetContainer() const
554 const wxRichTextObject
* p
= this;
559 return wxDynamicCast(p
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
);
566 void wxRichTextObject::SetMargins(int margin
)
568 SetMargins(margin
, margin
, margin
, margin
);
571 void wxRichTextObject::SetMargins(int leftMargin
, int rightMargin
, int topMargin
, int bottomMargin
)
573 GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetLeft().SetValue(leftMargin
, wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
574 GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetRight().SetValue(rightMargin
, wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
575 GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetTop().SetValue(topMargin
, wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
576 GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetBottom().SetValue(bottomMargin
, wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
579 int wxRichTextObject::GetLeftMargin() const
581 return GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetLeft().GetValue();
584 int wxRichTextObject::GetRightMargin() const
586 return GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetRight().GetValue();
589 int wxRichTextObject::GetTopMargin() const
591 return GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetTop().GetValue();
594 int wxRichTextObject::GetBottomMargin() const
596 return GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetBottom().GetValue();
599 // Calculate the available content space in the given rectangle, given the
600 // margins, border and padding specified in the object's attributes.
601 wxRect
wxRichTextObject::GetAvailableContentArea(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRect
& outerRect
) const
603 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
604 marginRect
= outerRect
;
605 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), GetAttributes(), marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
609 // Invalidate the buffer. With no argument, invalidates whole buffer.
610 void wxRichTextObject::Invalidate(const wxRichTextRange
& invalidRange
)
612 if (invalidRange
!= wxRICHTEXT_NONE
)
614 SetCachedSize(wxDefaultSize
);
615 SetMaxSize(wxDefaultSize
);
616 SetMinSize(wxDefaultSize
);
620 // Convert units in tenths of a millimetre to device units
621 int wxRichTextObject::ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(wxDC
& dc
, int units
) const
626 scale
= GetBuffer()->GetScale();
627 int p
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
.GetPPI().x
, units
, scale
);
632 // Convert units in tenths of a millimetre to device units
633 int wxRichTextObject::ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(int ppi
, int units
, double scale
)
635 // There are ppi pixels in 254.1 "1/10 mm"
637 double pixels
= ((double) units
* (double)ppi
) / 254.1;
641 // If the result is very small, make it at least one pixel in size.
642 if (pixels
== 0 && units
> 0)
648 // Convert units in pixels to tenths of a millimetre
649 int wxRichTextObject::ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(wxDC
& dc
, int pixels
) const
654 scale
= GetBuffer()->GetScale();
656 return ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(dc
.GetPPI().x
, p
, scale
);
659 int wxRichTextObject::ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(int ppi
, int pixels
, double scale
)
661 // There are ppi pixels in 254.1 "1/10 mm"
663 double p
= double(pixels
);
668 int units
= int( p
* 254.1 / (double) ppi
);
672 // Draw the borders and background for the given rectangle and attributes.
673 // Width and height are taken to be the outer margin size, not the content.
674 bool wxRichTextObject::DrawBoxAttributes(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, const wxRect
& boxRect
, int flags
)
676 // Assume boxRect is the area around the content
677 wxRect marginRect
= boxRect
;
678 wxRect contentRect
, borderRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
680 GetBoxRects(dc
, buffer
, attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
682 // Margin is transparent. Draw background from margin.
683 if (attr
.HasBackgroundColour() || (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_SELECTED
))
686 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_SELECTED
)
688 // TODO: get selection colour from control?
689 colour
= wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHT
);
692 colour
= attr
.GetBackgroundColour();
695 wxBrush
brush(colour
);
699 dc
.DrawRectangle(marginRect
);
702 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_GUIDELINES
)
704 wxRichTextAttr editBorderAttr
= attr
;
705 // TODO: make guideline colour configurable
706 editBorderAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().SetColour(*wxLIGHT_GREY
);
707 editBorderAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().SetWidth(1, wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
708 editBorderAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().SetStyle(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_SOLID
);
710 DrawBorder(dc
, buffer
, editBorderAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder(), borderRect
, flags
);
713 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().IsValid())
714 DrawBorder(dc
, buffer
, attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder(), borderRect
);
716 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().IsValid())
717 DrawBorder(dc
, buffer
, attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline(), outlineRect
);
723 bool wxRichTextObject::DrawBorder(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, const wxTextAttrBorders
& attr
, const wxRect
& rect
, int WXUNUSED(flags
))
725 int borderLeft
= 0, borderRight
= 0, borderTop
= 0, borderBottom
= 0;
726 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, buffer
? buffer
->GetScale() : 1.0);
728 if (attr
.GetLeft().IsValid() && attr
.GetLeft().GetStyle() != wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_NONE
)
730 borderLeft
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetLeft().GetWidth());
731 wxColour
col(attr
.GetLeft().GetColour());
733 // If pen width is > 1, resorts to a solid rectangle.
736 int penStyle
= wxSOLID
;
737 if (attr
.GetLeft().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DOTTED
)
739 else if (attr
.GetLeft().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DASHED
)
740 penStyle
= wxLONG_DASH
;
741 wxPen
pen(col
, 1, penStyle
);
743 dc
.DrawLine(rect
.x
, rect
.y
, rect
.x
, rect
.y
+ rect
.height
);
746 else if (borderLeft
> 1)
752 dc
.DrawRectangle(rect
.x
, rect
.y
, borderLeft
, rect
.height
);
756 if (attr
.GetRight().IsValid() && attr
.GetRight().GetStyle() != wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_NONE
)
758 borderRight
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetRight().GetWidth());
760 wxColour
col(attr
.GetRight().GetColour());
762 // If pen width is > 1, resorts to a solid rectangle.
763 if (borderRight
== 1)
765 int penStyle
= wxSOLID
;
766 if (attr
.GetRight().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DOTTED
)
768 else if (attr
.GetRight().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DASHED
)
769 penStyle
= wxLONG_DASH
;
770 wxPen
pen(col
, 1, penStyle
);
772 dc
.DrawLine(rect
.x
+ rect
.width
, rect
.y
, rect
.x
+ rect
.width
, rect
.y
+ rect
.height
+ 1);
775 else if (borderRight
> 1)
781 dc
.DrawRectangle(rect
.x
- borderRight
, rect
.y
, borderRight
, rect
.height
);
785 if (attr
.GetTop().IsValid() && attr
.GetTop().GetStyle() != wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_NONE
)
787 borderTop
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTop().GetWidth());
789 wxColour
col(attr
.GetTop().GetColour());
791 // If pen width is > 1, resorts to a solid rectangle.
794 int penStyle
= wxSOLID
;
795 if (attr
.GetTop().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DOTTED
)
797 else if (attr
.GetTop().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DASHED
)
798 penStyle
= wxLONG_DASH
;
799 wxPen
pen(col
, 1, penStyle
);
801 dc
.DrawLine(rect
.x
, rect
.y
, rect
.x
+ rect
.width
, rect
.y
);
804 else if (borderTop
> 1)
810 dc
.DrawRectangle(rect
.x
, rect
.y
, rect
.width
, borderTop
);
814 if (attr
.GetBottom().IsValid() && attr
.GetBottom().GetStyle() != wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_NONE
)
816 borderBottom
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetBottom().GetWidth());
817 wxColour
col(attr
.GetTop().GetColour());
819 // If pen width is > 1, resorts to a solid rectangle.
820 if (borderBottom
== 1)
822 int penStyle
= wxSOLID
;
823 if (attr
.GetBottom().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DOTTED
)
825 else if (attr
.GetBottom().GetStyle() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_DASHED
)
826 penStyle
= wxLONG_DASH
;
827 wxPen
pen(col
, 1, penStyle
);
829 dc
.DrawLine(rect
.x
, rect
.y
+ rect
.height
, rect
.x
+ rect
.width
, rect
.y
+ rect
.height
);
832 else if (borderBottom
> 1)
838 dc
.DrawRectangle(rect
.x
, rect
.y
- rect
.height
- borderBottom
, rect
.width
, borderBottom
);
845 // Get the various rectangles of the box model in pixels. You can either specify contentRect (inner)
846 // or marginRect (outer), and the other must be the default rectangle (no width or height).
847 // Note that the outline doesn't affect the position of the rectangle, it's drawn in whatever space
850 // | Margin | Border | Padding | CONTENT | Padding | Border | Margin |
852 bool wxRichTextObject::GetBoxRects(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, wxRect
& marginRect
, wxRect
& borderRect
, wxRect
& contentRect
, wxRect
& paddingRect
, wxRect
& outlineRect
)
854 int borderLeft
= 0, borderRight
= 0, borderTop
= 0, borderBottom
= 0;
855 int outlineLeft
= 0, outlineRight
= 0, outlineTop
= 0, outlineBottom
= 0;
856 int paddingLeft
= 0, paddingRight
= 0, paddingTop
= 0, paddingBottom
= 0;
857 int marginLeft
= 0, marginRight
= 0, marginTop
= 0, marginBottom
= 0;
859 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, buffer
? buffer
->GetScale() : 1.0);
861 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetLeft().IsValid())
862 marginLeft
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetLeft());
863 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetRight().IsValid())
864 marginRight
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetRight());
865 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetTop().IsValid())
866 marginTop
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetTop());
867 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetLeft().IsValid())
868 marginBottom
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetMargins().GetBottom());
870 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetLeft().GetWidth().IsValid())
871 borderLeft
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetLeft().GetWidth());
872 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetRight().GetWidth().IsValid())
873 borderRight
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetRight().GetWidth());
874 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetTop().GetWidth().IsValid())
875 borderTop
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetTop().GetWidth());
876 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetLeft().GetWidth().IsValid())
877 borderBottom
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetBorder().GetBottom().GetWidth());
879 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetLeft().IsValid())
880 paddingLeft
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetLeft());
881 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetRight().IsValid())
882 paddingRight
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetRight());
883 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetTop().IsValid())
884 paddingTop
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetTop());
885 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetBottom().IsValid())
886 paddingBottom
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetBottom());
888 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetLeft().GetWidth().IsValid())
889 outlineLeft
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetLeft().GetWidth());
890 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetRight().GetWidth().IsValid())
891 outlineRight
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetRight().GetWidth());
892 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetTop().GetWidth().IsValid())
893 outlineTop
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetTop().GetWidth());
894 if (attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetBottom().GetWidth().IsValid())
895 outlineBottom
= converter
.GetPixels(attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetOutline().GetBottom().GetWidth());
897 int leftTotal
= marginLeft
+ borderLeft
+ paddingLeft
;
898 int rightTotal
= marginRight
+ borderRight
+ paddingRight
;
899 int topTotal
= marginTop
+ borderTop
+ paddingTop
;
900 int bottomTotal
= marginBottom
+ borderBottom
+ paddingBottom
;
902 if (marginRect
!= wxRect())
904 contentRect
.x
= marginRect
.x
+ leftTotal
;
905 contentRect
.y
= marginRect
.y
+ topTotal
;
906 contentRect
.width
= marginRect
.width
- (leftTotal
+ rightTotal
);
907 contentRect
.height
= marginRect
.height
- (topTotal
+ bottomTotal
);
911 marginRect
.x
= contentRect
.x
- leftTotal
;
912 marginRect
.y
= contentRect
.y
- topTotal
;
913 marginRect
.width
= contentRect
.width
+ (leftTotal
+ rightTotal
);
914 marginRect
.height
= contentRect
.height
+ (topTotal
+ bottomTotal
);
917 borderRect
.x
= marginRect
.x
+ marginLeft
;
918 borderRect
.y
= marginRect
.y
+ marginTop
;
919 borderRect
.width
= marginRect
.width
- (marginLeft
+ marginRight
);
920 borderRect
.height
= marginRect
.height
- (marginTop
+ marginBottom
);
922 paddingRect
.x
= marginRect
.x
+ marginLeft
+ borderLeft
;
923 paddingRect
.y
= marginRect
.y
+ marginTop
+ borderTop
;
924 paddingRect
.width
= marginRect
.width
- (marginLeft
+ marginRight
+ borderLeft
+ borderRight
);
925 paddingRect
.height
= marginRect
.height
- (marginTop
+ marginBottom
+ borderTop
+ borderBottom
);
927 // The outline is outside the margin and doesn't influence the overall box position or content size.
928 outlineRect
.x
= marginRect
.x
- outlineLeft
;
929 outlineRect
.y
= marginRect
.y
- outlineTop
;
930 outlineRect
.width
= marginRect
.width
+ (outlineLeft
+ outlineRight
);
931 outlineRect
.height
= marginRect
.height
+ (outlineTop
+ outlineBottom
);
936 // Get the total margin for the object in pixels, taking into account margin, padding and border size
937 bool wxRichTextObject::GetTotalMargin(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, int& leftMargin
, int& rightMargin
,
938 int& topMargin
, int& bottomMargin
)
940 // Assume boxRect is the area around the content
941 wxRect contentRect
, marginRect
, borderRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
942 marginRect
= wxRect(0, 0, 1000, 1000);
944 GetBoxRects(dc
, buffer
, attr
, marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
946 leftMargin
= contentRect
.GetLeft() - marginRect
.GetLeft();
947 rightMargin
= marginRect
.GetRight() - contentRect
.GetRight();
948 topMargin
= contentRect
.GetTop() - marginRect
.GetTop();
949 bottomMargin
= marginRect
.GetBottom() - contentRect
.GetBottom();
954 // Returns the rectangle which the child has available to it given restrictions specified in the
955 // child attribute, e.g. 50% width of the parent, 400 pixels, x position 20% of the parent, etc.
956 wxRect
wxRichTextObject::AdjustAvailableSpace(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, const wxRichTextAttr
& WXUNUSED(parentAttr
), const wxRichTextAttr
& childAttr
, const wxRect
& availableParentSpace
)
958 wxRect rect
= availableParentSpace
;
961 scale
= buffer
->GetScale();
963 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, scale
, availableParentSpace
.GetSize());
965 if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().IsValid())
966 rect
.width
= converter
.GetPixels(childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth());
968 if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().IsValid())
969 rect
.height
= converter
.GetPixels(childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight());
971 // Can specify either left or right for the position (we're assuming we can't
972 // set the left and right edges to effectively set the size. Would we want to do that?)
973 if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetLeft().IsValid())
975 rect
.x
= rect
.x
+ converter
.GetPixels(childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetLeft());
977 else if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetRight().IsValid())
979 int x
= converter
.GetPixels(childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetRight());
980 if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetRight().GetPosition() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_POSITION_RELATIVE
)
981 rect
.x
= availableParentSpace
.x
+ availableParentSpace
.width
- rect
.width
;
986 if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetTop().IsValid())
988 rect
.y
= rect
.y
+ converter
.GetPixels(childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetTop());
990 else if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetBottom().IsValid())
992 int y
= converter
.GetPixels(childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetBottom());
993 if (childAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetPosition().GetBottom().GetPosition() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_POSITION_RELATIVE
)
994 rect
.y
= availableParentSpace
.y
+ availableParentSpace
.height
- rect
.height
;
1002 // Dump to output stream for debugging
1003 void wxRichTextObject::Dump(wxTextOutputStream
& stream
)
1005 stream
<< GetClassInfo()->GetClassName() << wxT("\n");
1006 stream
<< wxString::Format(wxT("Size: %d,%d. Position: %d,%d, Range: %ld,%ld"), m_size
.x
, m_size
.y
, m_pos
.x
, m_pos
.y
, m_range
.GetStart(), m_range
.GetEnd()) << wxT("\n");
1007 stream
<< wxString::Format(wxT("Text colour: %d,%d,%d."), (int) m_attributes
.GetTextColour().Red(), (int) m_attributes
.GetTextColour().Green(), (int) m_attributes
.GetTextColour().Blue()) << wxT("\n");
1010 // Gets the containing buffer
1011 wxRichTextBuffer
* wxRichTextObject::GetBuffer() const
1013 const wxRichTextObject
* obj
= this;
1014 while (obj
&& !obj
->IsKindOf(CLASSINFO(wxRichTextBuffer
)))
1015 obj
= obj
->GetParent();
1016 return wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextBuffer
);
1019 // Get the absolute object position, by traversing up the child/parent hierarchy
1020 wxPoint
wxRichTextObject::GetAbsolutePosition() const
1022 wxPoint pt
= GetPosition();
1024 wxRichTextObject
* p
= GetParent();
1027 pt
= pt
+ p
->GetPosition();
1034 // Hit-testing: returns a flag indicating hit test details, plus
1035 // information about position
1036 int wxRichTextObject::HitTest(wxDC
& WXUNUSED(dc
), const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, wxRichTextObject
** contextObj
, int WXUNUSED(flags
))
1039 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
1041 wxRect rect
= GetRect();
1042 if (pt
.x
>= rect
.x
&& pt
.x
< rect
.x
+ rect
.width
&&
1043 pt
.y
>= rect
.y
&& pt
.y
< rect
.y
+ rect
.height
)
1046 *contextObj
= GetParentContainer();
1047 textPosition
= GetRange().GetStart();
1048 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_ON
;
1051 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
1054 // Lays out the object first with a given amount of space, and then if no width was specified in attr,
1055 // lays out the object again using the maximum ('best') size
1056 bool wxRichTextObject::LayoutToBestSize(wxDC
& dc
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
,
1057 const wxRichTextAttr
& parentAttr
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, const wxRect
& availableParentSpace
,
1060 wxRect availableChildRect
= AdjustAvailableSpace(dc
, buffer
, parentAttr
, attr
, availableParentSpace
);
1061 wxRect originalAvailableRect
= availableChildRect
;
1062 Layout(dc
, availableChildRect
, style
);
1064 wxSize maxSize
= GetMaxSize();
1066 // Don't ignore if maxSize.x is zero, since we need to redo the paragraph's lines
1068 if (!attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().IsValid() && maxSize
.x
< availableChildRect
.width
/* && maxSize.x > 0 */)
1070 // Redo the layout with a fixed, minimum size this time.
1071 Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
1072 wxRichTextAttr
newAttr(attr
);
1073 newAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().SetValue(maxSize
.x
, wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
1074 newAttr
.GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().SetPosition(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_POSITION_ABSOLUTE
);
1076 availableChildRect
= AdjustAvailableSpace(dc
, buffer
, parentAttr
, newAttr
, availableParentSpace
);
1078 // If a paragraph, align the whole paragraph.
1079 // Problem with this: if we're limited by a floating object, a line may be centered
1080 // w.r.t. the smaller resulting box rather than the actual available width.
1081 if (attr
.HasAlignment() && !GetContainer()->GetFloatCollector()->HasFloats()) // FIXME: aligning whole paragraph not compatible with floating objects
1083 // centering, right-justification
1084 if (GetAttributes().GetAlignment() == wxTEXT_ALIGNMENT_CENTRE
)
1086 availableChildRect
.x
= (originalAvailableRect
.GetWidth() - availableChildRect
.GetWidth())/2 + availableChildRect
.x
;
1088 else if (GetAttributes().GetAlignment() == wxTEXT_ALIGNMENT_RIGHT
)
1090 availableChildRect
.x
= availableChildRect
.x
+ originalAvailableRect
.GetWidth() - availableChildRect
.GetWidth();
1094 Layout(dc
, availableChildRect
, style
);
1108 // Move the object recursively, by adding the offset from old to new
1109 void wxRichTextObject::Move(const wxPoint
& pt
)
1116 * wxRichTextCompositeObject
1117 * This is the base for drawable objects.
1120 IMPLEMENT_CLASS(wxRichTextCompositeObject
, wxRichTextObject
)
1122 wxRichTextCompositeObject::wxRichTextCompositeObject(wxRichTextObject
* parent
):
1123 wxRichTextObject(parent
)
1127 wxRichTextCompositeObject::~wxRichTextCompositeObject()
1132 /// Get the nth child
1133 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextCompositeObject::GetChild(size_t n
) const
1135 wxASSERT ( n
< m_children
.GetCount() );
1137 return m_children
.Item(n
)->GetData();
1140 /// Append a child, returning the position
1141 size_t wxRichTextCompositeObject::AppendChild(wxRichTextObject
* child
)
1143 m_children
.Append(child
);
1144 child
->SetParent(this);
1145 return m_children
.GetCount() - 1;
1148 /// Insert the child in front of the given object, or at the beginning
1149 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::InsertChild(wxRichTextObject
* child
, wxRichTextObject
* inFrontOf
)
1153 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.Find(inFrontOf
);
1154 m_children
.Insert(node
, child
);
1157 m_children
.Insert(child
);
1158 child
->SetParent(this);
1163 /// Delete the child
1164 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::RemoveChild(wxRichTextObject
* child
, bool deleteChild
)
1166 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.Find(child
);
1169 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= node
->GetData();
1170 m_children
.Erase(node
);
1179 /// Delete all children
1180 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::DeleteChildren()
1182 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1185 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator oldNode
= node
;
1187 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1188 child
->Dereference(); // Only delete if reference count is zero
1190 node
= node
->GetNext();
1191 m_children
.Erase(oldNode
);
1197 /// Get the child count
1198 size_t wxRichTextCompositeObject::GetChildCount() const
1200 return m_children
.GetCount();
1204 void wxRichTextCompositeObject::Copy(const wxRichTextCompositeObject
& obj
)
1206 wxRichTextObject::Copy(obj
);
1210 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= obj
.m_children
.GetFirst();
1213 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1214 wxRichTextObject
* newChild
= child
->Clone();
1215 newChild
->SetParent(this);
1216 m_children
.Append(newChild
);
1218 node
= node
->GetNext();
1222 /// Hit-testing: returns a flag indicating hit test details, plus
1223 /// information about position
1224 int wxRichTextCompositeObject::HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, wxRichTextObject
** contextObj
, int flags
)
1227 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
1229 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1232 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1234 if (child
->IsShown() && child
->IsTopLevel() && (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NO_NESTED_OBJECTS
))
1236 // Just check if we hit the overall object
1237 int ret
= child
->wxRichTextObject::HitTest(dc
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, contextObj
, flags
);
1238 if (ret
!= wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
1241 else if (child
->IsShown())
1243 int ret
= child
->HitTest(dc
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, contextObj
, flags
);
1244 if (ret
!= wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
1248 node
= node
->GetNext();
1251 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
1254 /// Finds the absolute position and row height for the given character position
1255 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::FindPosition(wxDC
& dc
, long index
, wxPoint
& pt
, int* height
, bool forceLineStart
)
1257 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1260 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1262 // Don't recurse if the child is a top-level object,
1263 // such as a text box, because the character position will no longer
1264 // apply. By definition, a top-level object has its own range of
1265 // character positions.
1266 if (!child
->IsTopLevel() && child
->FindPosition(dc
, index
, pt
, height
, forceLineStart
))
1269 node
= node
->GetNext();
1276 void wxRichTextCompositeObject::CalculateRange(long start
, long& end
)
1278 long current
= start
;
1279 long lastEnd
= current
;
1287 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1290 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1293 child
->CalculateRange(current
, childEnd
);
1296 current
= childEnd
+ 1;
1298 node
= node
->GetNext();
1303 // A top-level object always has a range of size 1,
1304 // because its children don't count at this level.
1306 m_range
.SetRange(start
, start
);
1308 // An object with no children has zero length
1309 if (m_children
.GetCount() == 0)
1311 m_ownRange
.SetRange(0, lastEnd
);
1317 // An object with no children has zero length
1318 if (m_children
.GetCount() == 0)
1321 m_range
.SetRange(start
, end
);
1325 /// Delete range from layout.
1326 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::DeleteRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
)
1328 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1332 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= (wxRichTextObject
*) node
->GetData();
1333 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator next
= node
->GetNext();
1335 // Delete the range in each paragraph
1337 // When a chunk has been deleted, internally the content does not
1338 // now match the ranges.
1339 // However, so long as deletion is not done on the same object twice this is OK.
1340 // If you may delete content from the same object twice, recalculate
1341 // the ranges inbetween DeleteRange calls by calling CalculateRanges, and
1342 // adjust the range you're deleting accordingly.
1344 if (!obj
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
1346 // No need to delete within a top-level object; just removing this object will do fine
1347 if (!obj
->IsTopLevel())
1348 obj
->DeleteRange(range
);
1350 // Delete an empty object, or paragraph within this range.
1351 if (obj
->IsEmpty() ||
1352 (range
.GetStart() <= obj
->GetRange().GetStart() && range
.GetEnd() >= obj
->GetRange().GetEnd()))
1354 // An empty paragraph has length 1, so won't be deleted unless the
1355 // whole range is deleted.
1356 RemoveChild(obj
, true);
1366 /// Get any text in this object for the given range
1367 wxString
wxRichTextCompositeObject::GetTextForRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
) const
1370 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1373 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1374 wxRichTextRange childRange
= range
;
1375 if (!child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
1377 childRange
.LimitTo(child
->GetRange());
1379 wxString childText
= child
->GetTextForRange(childRange
);
1383 node
= node
->GetNext();
1389 /// Get the child object at the given character position
1390 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextCompositeObject::GetChildAtPosition(long pos
) const
1392 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1395 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1396 if (child
->GetRange().GetStart() == pos
)
1398 node
= node
->GetNext();
1403 /// Recursively merge all pieces that can be merged.
1404 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::Defragment(const wxRichTextRange
& range
)
1406 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1409 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1410 if (range
== wxRICHTEXT_ALL
|| !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
1412 wxRichTextCompositeObject
* composite
= wxDynamicCast(child
, wxRichTextCompositeObject
);
1414 composite
->Defragment();
1416 if (node
->GetNext())
1418 wxRichTextObject
* nextChild
= node
->GetNext()->GetData();
1419 if (child
->CanMerge(nextChild
) && child
->Merge(nextChild
))
1421 nextChild
->Dereference();
1422 m_children
.Erase(node
->GetNext());
1424 // Don't set node -- we'll see if we can merge again with the next
1428 node
= node
->GetNext();
1431 node
= node
->GetNext();
1434 node
= node
->GetNext();
1437 // Delete any remaining empty objects, but leave at least one empty object per composite object.
1438 if (GetChildCount() > 1)
1440 node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1443 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator next
= node
->GetNext();
1444 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1445 if (range
== wxRICHTEXT_ALL
|| !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
1447 if (child
->IsEmpty())
1449 child
->Dereference();
1450 m_children
.Erase(node
);
1455 node
= node
->GetNext();
1462 /// Dump to output stream for debugging
1463 void wxRichTextCompositeObject::Dump(wxTextOutputStream
& stream
)
1465 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1468 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1469 child
->Dump(stream
);
1470 node
= node
->GetNext();
1474 /// Get/set the object size for the given range. Returns false if the range
1475 /// is invalid for this object.
1476 bool wxRichTextCompositeObject::GetRangeSize(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& descent
, wxDC
& dc
, int flags
, wxPoint position
, wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
) const
1478 if (!range
.IsWithin(GetRange()))
1483 wxArrayInt childExtents
;
1490 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1493 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1494 if (!child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
1496 // Floating objects have a zero size within the paragraph.
1497 if (child
->IsFloating())
1502 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
1503 lastSize
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
1507 partialExtents
->Add(0 /* zero size */ + lastSize
);
1514 wxRichTextRange rangeToUse
= range
;
1515 rangeToUse
.LimitTo(child
->GetRange());
1516 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
1517 rangeToUse
= child
->GetOwnRange();
1519 int childDescent
= 0;
1521 // At present wxRICHTEXT_HEIGHT_ONLY is only fast if we're already cached the size,
1522 // but it's only going to be used after caching has taken place.
1523 if ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_HEIGHT_ONLY
) && child
->GetCachedSize().y
!= 0)
1525 childDescent
= child
->GetDescent();
1526 childSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
1528 sz
.y
= wxMax(sz
.y
, childSize
.y
);
1529 sz
.x
+= childSize
.x
;
1530 descent
= wxMax(descent
, childDescent
);
1532 else if (child
->GetRangeSize(rangeToUse
, childSize
, childDescent
, dc
, flags
, wxPoint(position
.x
+ sz
.x
, position
.y
), p
))
1534 sz
.y
= wxMax(sz
.y
, childSize
.y
);
1535 sz
.x
+= childSize
.x
;
1536 descent
= wxMax(descent
, childDescent
);
1538 if ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_CACHE_SIZE
) && (rangeToUse
== child
->GetRange() || child
->IsTopLevel()))
1540 child
->SetCachedSize(childSize
);
1541 child
->SetDescent(childDescent
);
1547 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
1548 lastSize
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
1553 for (i
= 0; i
< childExtents
.GetCount(); i
++)
1555 partialExtents
->Add(childExtents
[i
] + lastSize
);
1565 node
= node
->GetNext();
1571 // Invalidate the buffer. With no argument, invalidates whole buffer.
1572 void wxRichTextCompositeObject::Invalidate(const wxRichTextRange
& invalidRange
)
1574 wxRichTextObject::Invalidate(invalidRange
);
1576 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1579 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1580 if (invalidRange
!= wxRICHTEXT_ALL
&& invalidRange
!= wxRICHTEXT_NONE
&& child
->GetRange().IsOutside(invalidRange
))
1584 else if (child
->IsTopLevel())
1586 if (invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_NONE
)
1587 child
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_NONE
);
1589 child
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
); // All children must be invalidated if within parent range
1592 child
->Invalidate(invalidRange
);
1593 node
= node
->GetNext();
1597 // Move the object recursively, by adding the offset from old to new
1598 void wxRichTextCompositeObject::Move(const wxPoint
& pt
)
1600 wxPoint oldPos
= GetPosition();
1602 wxPoint offset
= pt
- oldPos
;
1604 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1607 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1608 wxPoint childPos
= child
->GetPosition() + offset
;
1609 child
->Move(childPos
);
1610 node
= node
->GetNext();
1616 * wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
1617 * This box knows how to lay out paragraphs.
1620 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
, wxRichTextCompositeObject
)
1622 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox(wxRichTextObject
* parent
):
1623 wxRichTextCompositeObject(parent
)
1628 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::~wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox()
1630 if (m_floatCollector
)
1632 delete m_floatCollector
;
1633 m_floatCollector
= NULL
;
1637 /// Initialize the object.
1638 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Init()
1642 // For now, assume is the only box and has no initial size.
1643 m_range
= wxRichTextRange(0, -1);
1644 m_ownRange
= wxRichTextRange(0, -1);
1646 m_invalidRange
= wxRICHTEXT_ALL
;
1649 m_partialParagraph
= false;
1650 m_floatCollector
= NULL
;
1653 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Clear()
1657 if (m_floatCollector
)
1658 delete m_floatCollector
;
1659 m_floatCollector
= NULL
;
1660 m_partialParagraph
= false;
1664 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Copy(const wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
& obj
)
1668 wxRichTextCompositeObject::Copy(obj
);
1670 m_partialParagraph
= obj
.m_partialParagraph
;
1671 m_defaultAttributes
= obj
.m_defaultAttributes
;
1674 // Gather information about floating objects; only gather floats for those paragraphs that
1675 // will not be formatted again due to optimization, after which floats will be gathered per-paragraph
1677 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::UpdateFloatingObjects(const wxRect
& availableRect
, wxRichTextObject
* untilObj
)
1679 if (m_floatCollector
!= NULL
)
1680 delete m_floatCollector
;
1681 m_floatCollector
= new wxRichTextFloatCollector(availableRect
);
1682 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1683 // Only gather floats up to the point we'll start formatting paragraphs.
1684 while (untilObj
&& node
&& node
->GetData() != untilObj
)
1686 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
1687 wxASSERT (child
!= NULL
);
1689 m_floatCollector
->CollectFloat(child
);
1690 node
= node
->GetNext();
1696 // Returns the style sheet associated with the overall buffer.
1697 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetStyleSheet() const
1699 return GetBuffer() ? GetBuffer()->GetStyleSheet() : (wxRichTextStyleSheet
*) NULL
;
1702 // Get the number of floating objects at this level
1703 int wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetFloatingObjectCount() const
1705 if (m_floatCollector
)
1706 return m_floatCollector
->GetFloatingObjectCount();
1711 // Get a list of floating objects
1712 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetFloatingObjects(wxRichTextObjectList
& objects
) const
1714 if (m_floatCollector
)
1716 return m_floatCollector
->GetFloatingObjects(objects
);
1723 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::UpdateRanges()
1727 start
= GetRange().GetStart();
1729 CalculateRange(start
, end
);
1733 int wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, wxRichTextObject
** contextObj
, int flags
)
1736 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
1738 int ret
= wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
1739 if (m_floatCollector
&& (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NO_FLOATING_OBJECTS
) == 0)
1740 ret
= m_floatCollector
->HitTest(dc
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, flags
);
1742 if (ret
== wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
1743 return wxRichTextCompositeObject::HitTest(dc
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, contextObj
, flags
);
1751 /// Draw the floating objects
1752 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::DrawFloats(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
1754 if (m_floatCollector
)
1755 m_floatCollector
->Draw(dc
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
1758 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::MoveAnchoredObjectToParagraph(wxRichTextParagraph
* from
, wxRichTextParagraph
* to
, wxRichTextObject
* obj
)
1763 from
->RemoveChild(obj
);
1764 to
->AppendChild(obj
);
1768 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
1773 wxRect
thisRect(GetPosition(), GetCachedSize());
1776 if (selection
.IsValid() && GetParentContainer() != this && selection
.WithinSelection(GetRange().GetStart(), GetParentContainer()))
1777 flags
|= wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_SELECTED
;
1779 // Don't draw guidelines if at top level
1780 int theseFlags
= flags
;
1782 theseFlags
&= ~wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_GUIDELINES
;
1783 DrawBoxAttributes(dc
, GetBuffer(), GetAttributes(), thisRect
, theseFlags
);
1785 DrawFloats(dc
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
1786 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1789 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
1791 if (child
&& !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
1793 wxRect
childRect(child
->GetPosition(), child
->GetCachedSize());
1794 wxRichTextRange childRange
= range
;
1795 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
1797 childRange
= child
->GetOwnRange();
1800 if (((style
& wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_IGNORE_CACHE
) == 0) && childRect
.GetTop() > rect
.GetBottom())
1805 else if (((style
& wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_IGNORE_CACHE
) == 0) && childRect
.GetBottom() < rect
.GetTop())
1810 child
->Draw(dc
, childRange
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
1813 node
= node
->GetNext();
1818 /// Lay the item out
1819 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Layout(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRect
& rect
, int style
)
1821 SetPosition(rect
.GetPosition());
1826 wxRect availableSpace
;
1827 bool formatRect
= (style
& wxRICHTEXT_LAYOUT_SPECIFIED_RECT
) == wxRICHTEXT_LAYOUT_SPECIFIED_RECT
;
1829 // If only laying out a specific area, the passed rect has a different meaning:
1830 // the visible part of the buffer. This is used in wxRichTextCtrl::OnSize,
1831 // so that during a size, only the visible part will be relaid out, or
1832 // it would take too long causing flicker. As an approximation, we assume that
1833 // everything up to the start of the visible area is laid out correctly.
1836 wxRect
rect2(0, 0, rect
.width
, rect
.height
);
1837 availableSpace
= GetAvailableContentArea(dc
, rect2
);
1839 // Invalidate the part of the buffer from the first visible line
1840 // to the end. If other parts of the buffer are currently invalid,
1841 // then they too will be taken into account if they are above
1842 // the visible point.
1844 wxRichTextLine
* line
= GetLineAtYPosition(rect
.y
);
1846 startPos
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange().GetStart();
1848 Invalidate(wxRichTextRange(startPos
, GetOwnRange().GetEnd()));
1852 availableSpace
= GetAvailableContentArea(dc
, rect
);
1855 int leftMargin
, rightMargin
, topMargin
, bottomMargin
;
1856 wxRichTextObject::GetTotalMargin(dc
, GetBuffer(), GetAttributes(), leftMargin
, rightMargin
,
1857 topMargin
, bottomMargin
);
1862 // The maximum paragraph maximum width, so we can set the overall maximum width for this object
1863 int maxMaxWidth
= 0;
1865 // The maximum paragraph minimum width, so we can set the overall minimum width for this object
1866 int maxMinWidth
= 0;
1868 // If we have vertical alignment, we must recalculate everything.
1869 bool hasVerticalAlignment
= (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().HasVerticalAlignment() &&
1870 (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetVerticalAlignment() > wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_TOP
));
1872 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1874 bool layoutAll
= true;
1876 // Get invalid range, rounding to paragraph start/end.
1877 wxRichTextRange invalidRange
= GetInvalidRange(true);
1879 if (invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_NONE
&& !formatRect
)
1882 if (invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_ALL
|| hasVerticalAlignment
)
1884 else // If we know what range is affected, start laying out from that point on.
1885 if (invalidRange
.GetStart() >= GetOwnRange().GetStart())
1887 wxRichTextParagraph
* firstParagraph
= GetParagraphAtPosition(invalidRange
.GetStart());
1890 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator firstNode
= m_children
.Find(firstParagraph
);
1891 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator previousNode
;
1893 previousNode
= firstNode
->GetPrevious();
1898 wxRichTextParagraph
* previousParagraph
= wxDynamicCast(previousNode
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
1899 availableSpace
.y
= previousParagraph
->GetPosition().y
+ previousParagraph
->GetCachedSize().y
;
1902 // Now we're going to start iterating from the first affected paragraph.
1910 // Gather information about only those floating objects that will not be formatted,
1911 // after which floats will be gathered per-paragraph during layout.
1912 UpdateFloatingObjects(availableSpace
, node
? node
->GetData() : (wxRichTextObject
*) NULL
);
1914 // A way to force speedy rest-of-buffer layout (the 'else' below)
1915 bool forceQuickLayout
= false;
1917 // First get the size of the paragraphs we won't be laying out
1918 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator n
= m_children
.GetFirst();
1919 while (n
&& n
!= node
)
1921 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(n
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
1924 maxWidth
= wxMax(maxWidth
, child
->GetCachedSize().x
);
1925 maxMinWidth
= wxMax(maxMinWidth
, child
->GetMinSize().x
);
1926 maxMaxWidth
= wxMax(maxMaxWidth
, child
->GetMaxSize().x
);
1933 // Assume this box only contains paragraphs
1935 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
1936 // Unsure if this is needed
1937 // wxCHECK_MSG( child, false, wxT("Unknown object in layout") );
1939 if (child
&& child
->IsShown())
1941 // TODO: what if the child hasn't been laid out (e.g. involved in Undo) but still has 'old' lines
1942 if ( !forceQuickLayout
&&
1944 child
->GetLines().IsEmpty() ||
1945 !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(invalidRange
)) )
1947 // Lays out the object first with a given amount of space, and then if no width was specified in attr,
1948 // lays out the object again using the minimum size
1949 child
->LayoutToBestSize(dc
, GetBuffer(),
1950 GetAttributes(), child
->GetAttributes(), availableSpace
, style
&~wxRICHTEXT_LAYOUT_SPECIFIED_RECT
);
1952 // Layout must set the cached size
1953 availableSpace
.y
+= child
->GetCachedSize().y
;
1954 maxWidth
= wxMax(maxWidth
, child
->GetCachedSize().x
);
1955 maxMinWidth
= wxMax(maxMinWidth
, child
->GetMinSize().x
);
1956 maxMaxWidth
= wxMax(maxMaxWidth
, child
->GetMaxSize().x
);
1958 // If we're just formatting the visible part of the buffer,
1959 // and we're now past the bottom of the window, and we don't have any
1960 // floating objects (since they may cause wrapping to change for the rest of the
1961 // the buffer), start quick layout.
1962 if (!hasVerticalAlignment
&& formatRect
&& child
->GetPosition().y
> rect
.GetBottom() && GetFloatingObjectCount() == 0)
1963 forceQuickLayout
= true;
1967 // We're outside the immediately affected range, so now let's just
1968 // move everything up or down. This assumes that all the children have previously
1969 // been laid out and have wrapped line lists associated with them.
1970 // TODO: check all paragraphs before the affected range.
1972 int inc
= availableSpace
.y
- child
->GetPosition().y
;
1976 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
1979 if (child
->GetLines().GetCount() == 0)
1981 // Lays out the object first with a given amount of space, and then if no width was specified in attr,
1982 // lays out the object again using the minimum size
1983 child
->LayoutToBestSize(dc
, GetBuffer(),
1984 GetAttributes(), child
->GetAttributes(), availableSpace
, style
&~wxRICHTEXT_LAYOUT_SPECIFIED_RECT
);
1986 //child->Layout(dc, availableChildRect, style);
1989 child
->Move(wxPoint(child
->GetPosition().x
, child
->GetPosition().y
+ inc
));
1991 availableSpace
.y
+= child
->GetCachedSize().y
;
1992 maxWidth
= wxMax(maxWidth
, child
->GetCachedSize().x
);
1993 maxMinWidth
= wxMax(maxMinWidth
, child
->GetMinSize().x
);
1994 maxMaxWidth
= wxMax(maxMaxWidth
, child
->GetMaxSize().x
);
1997 node
= node
->GetNext();
2003 node
= node
->GetNext();
2006 node
= m_children
.GetLast();
2007 if (node
&& node
->GetData()->IsShown())
2009 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
2010 // maxHeight = (child->GetPosition().y - GetPosition().y) + child->GetCachedSize().y;
2011 maxHeight
= child
->GetPosition().y
- (GetPosition().y
+ topMargin
) + child
->GetCachedSize().y
;
2014 maxHeight
= 0; // topMargin + bottomMargin;
2016 // TODO: (also in para layout) should set the
2017 // object's size to an absolute one if specified,
2018 // but if not specified, calculate it from content.
2020 // We need to add back the margins etc.
2022 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
2023 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(maxWidth
, maxHeight
));
2024 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), GetAttributes(), marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
2025 SetCachedSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
2028 // The maximum size is the greatest of all maximum widths for all paragraphs.
2030 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
2031 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(maxMaxWidth
, maxHeight
)); // Actually max height is a lie, we can't know it
2032 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), GetAttributes(), marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
2033 SetMaxSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
2036 // The minimum size is the greatest of all minimum widths for all paragraphs.
2038 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
2039 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(maxMinWidth
, maxHeight
)); // Actually max height is a lie, we can't know it
2040 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), GetAttributes(), marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
2041 SetMinSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
2044 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().HasVerticalAlignment() &&
2045 (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetVerticalAlignment() > wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_TOP
))
2048 int leftOverSpace
= availableSpace
.height
- topMargin
- bottomMargin
- maxHeight
;
2049 if (leftOverSpace
> 0)
2051 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetVerticalAlignment() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_CENTRE
)
2053 yOffset
= (leftOverSpace
/2);
2055 else if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetVerticalAlignment() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_BOTTOM
)
2057 yOffset
= leftOverSpace
;
2061 // Move all the children to vertically align the content
2062 // This doesn't take into account floating objects, unfortunately.
2065 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2068 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2070 child
->Move(wxPoint(child
->GetPosition().x
, child
->GetPosition().y
+ yOffset
));
2072 node
= node
->GetNext();
2077 m_invalidRange
= wxRICHTEXT_NONE
;
2082 /// Get/set the size for the given range.
2083 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetRangeSize(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& descent
, wxDC
& dc
, int flags
, wxPoint position
, wxArrayInt
* WXUNUSED(partialExtents
)) const
2087 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator startPara
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
2088 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator endPara
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
2090 // First find the first paragraph whose starting position is within the range.
2091 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2094 // child is a paragraph
2095 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
2096 const wxRichTextRange
& r
= child
->GetRange();
2098 if (r
.GetStart() <= range
.GetStart() && r
.GetEnd() >= range
.GetStart())
2104 node
= node
->GetNext();
2107 // Next find the last paragraph containing part of the range
2108 node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2111 // child is a paragraph
2112 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
2113 const wxRichTextRange
& r
= child
->GetRange();
2115 if (r
.GetStart() <= range
.GetEnd() && r
.GetEnd() >= range
.GetEnd())
2121 node
= node
->GetNext();
2124 if (!startPara
|| !endPara
)
2127 // Now we can add up the sizes
2128 for (node
= startPara
; node
; node
= node
->GetNext())
2130 // child is a paragraph
2131 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
2132 const wxRichTextRange
& childRange
= child
->GetRange();
2133 wxRichTextRange rangeToFind
= range
;
2134 rangeToFind
.LimitTo(childRange
);
2136 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
2137 rangeToFind
= child
->GetOwnRange();
2141 int childDescent
= 0;
2142 child
->GetRangeSize(rangeToFind
, childSize
, childDescent
, dc
, flags
, position
);
2144 descent
= wxMax(childDescent
, descent
);
2146 sz
.x
= wxMax(sz
.x
, childSize
.x
);
2147 sz
.y
+= childSize
.y
;
2149 if (node
== endPara
)
2158 /// Get the paragraph at the given position
2159 wxRichTextParagraph
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetParagraphAtPosition(long pos
, bool caretPosition
) const
2164 // First find the first paragraph whose starting position is within the range.
2165 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2168 // child is a paragraph
2169 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2170 // wxASSERT (child != NULL);
2174 // Return first child in buffer if position is -1
2178 if (child
->GetRange().Contains(pos
))
2182 node
= node
->GetNext();
2187 /// Get the line at the given position
2188 wxRichTextLine
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetLineAtPosition(long pos
, bool caretPosition
) const
2193 // First find the first paragraph whose starting position is within the range.
2194 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2197 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= (wxRichTextObject
*) node
->GetData();
2198 if (obj
->GetRange().Contains(pos
))
2200 // child is a paragraph
2201 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextParagraph
);
2202 // wxASSERT (child != NULL);
2206 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node2
= child
->GetLines().GetFirst();
2209 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node2
->GetData();
2211 wxRichTextRange range
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
2213 if (range
.Contains(pos
) ||
2215 // If the position is end-of-paragraph, then return the last line of
2216 // of the paragraph.
2217 ((range
.GetEnd() == child
->GetRange().GetEnd()-1) && (pos
== child
->GetRange().GetEnd())))
2220 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
2225 node
= node
->GetNext();
2228 int lineCount
= GetLineCount();
2230 return GetLineForVisibleLineNumber(lineCount
-1);
2235 /// Get the line at the given y pixel position, or the last line.
2236 wxRichTextLine
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetLineAtYPosition(int y
) const
2238 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2241 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2242 // wxASSERT (child != NULL);
2246 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node2
= child
->GetLines().GetFirst();
2249 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node2
->GetData();
2251 wxRect
rect(line
->GetRect());
2253 if (y
<= rect
.GetBottom())
2256 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
2260 node
= node
->GetNext();
2264 int lineCount
= GetLineCount();
2266 return GetLineForVisibleLineNumber(lineCount
-1);
2271 /// Get the number of visible lines
2272 int wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetLineCount() const
2276 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2279 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2280 // wxASSERT (child != NULL);
2283 count
+= child
->GetLines().GetCount();
2285 node
= node
->GetNext();
2291 /// Get the paragraph for a given line
2292 wxRichTextParagraph
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetParagraphForLine(wxRichTextLine
* line
) const
2294 return GetParagraphAtPosition(line
->GetAbsoluteRange().GetStart());
2297 /// Get the line size at the given position
2298 wxSize
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetLineSizeAtPosition(long pos
, bool caretPosition
) const
2300 wxRichTextLine
* line
= GetLineAtPosition(pos
, caretPosition
);
2303 return line
->GetSize();
2306 return wxSize(0, 0);
2310 /// Convenience function to add a paragraph of text
2311 wxRichTextRange
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::AddParagraph(const wxString
& text
, wxRichTextAttr
* paraStyle
)
2313 // Don't use the base style, just the default style, and the base style will
2314 // be combined at display time.
2315 // Divide into paragraph and character styles.
2317 wxRichTextAttr defaultCharStyle
;
2318 wxRichTextAttr defaultParaStyle
;
2320 // If the default style is a named paragraph style, don't apply any character formatting
2321 // to the initial text string.
2322 if (GetDefaultStyle().HasParagraphStyleName() && GetStyleSheet())
2324 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(GetDefaultStyle().GetParagraphStyleName());
2326 defaultParaStyle
= def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(GetStyleSheet());
2329 wxRichTextSplitParaCharStyles(GetDefaultStyle(), defaultParaStyle
, defaultCharStyle
);
2331 wxRichTextAttr
* pStyle
= paraStyle
? paraStyle
: (wxRichTextAttr
*) & defaultParaStyle
;
2332 wxRichTextAttr
* cStyle
= & defaultCharStyle
;
2334 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= new wxRichTextParagraph(text
, this, pStyle
, cStyle
);
2340 return para
->GetRange();
2343 /// Adds multiple paragraphs, based on newlines.
2344 wxRichTextRange
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::AddParagraphs(const wxString
& text
, wxRichTextAttr
* paraStyle
)
2346 // Don't use the base style, just the default style, and the base style will
2347 // be combined at display time.
2348 // Divide into paragraph and character styles.
2350 wxRichTextAttr defaultCharStyle
;
2351 wxRichTextAttr defaultParaStyle
;
2353 // If the default style is a named paragraph style, don't apply any character formatting
2354 // to the initial text string.
2355 if (GetDefaultStyle().HasParagraphStyleName() && GetStyleSheet())
2357 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(GetDefaultStyle().GetParagraphStyleName());
2359 defaultParaStyle
= def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(GetStyleSheet());
2362 wxRichTextSplitParaCharStyles(GetDefaultStyle(), defaultParaStyle
, defaultCharStyle
);
2364 wxRichTextAttr
* pStyle
= paraStyle
? paraStyle
: (wxRichTextAttr
*) & defaultParaStyle
;
2365 wxRichTextAttr
* cStyle
= & defaultCharStyle
;
2367 wxRichTextParagraph
* firstPara
= NULL
;
2368 wxRichTextParagraph
* lastPara
= NULL
;
2370 wxRichTextRange
range(-1, -1);
2373 size_t len
= text
.length();
2375 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= new wxRichTextParagraph(wxEmptyString
, this, pStyle
, cStyle
);
2384 wxChar ch
= text
[i
];
2385 if (ch
== wxT('\n') || ch
== wxT('\r'))
2389 wxRichTextPlainText
* plainText
= (wxRichTextPlainText
*) para
->GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData();
2390 plainText
->SetText(line
);
2392 para
= new wxRichTextParagraph(wxEmptyString
, this, pStyle
, cStyle
);
2397 line
= wxEmptyString
;
2408 wxRichTextPlainText
* plainText
= (wxRichTextPlainText
*) para
->GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData();
2409 plainText
->SetText(line
);
2414 return wxRichTextRange(firstPara
->GetRange().GetStart(), lastPara
->GetRange().GetEnd());
2417 /// Convenience function to add an image
2418 wxRichTextRange
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::AddImage(const wxImage
& image
, wxRichTextAttr
* paraStyle
)
2420 // Don't use the base style, just the default style, and the base style will
2421 // be combined at display time.
2422 // Divide into paragraph and character styles.
2424 wxRichTextAttr defaultCharStyle
;
2425 wxRichTextAttr defaultParaStyle
;
2427 // If the default style is a named paragraph style, don't apply any character formatting
2428 // to the initial text string.
2429 if (GetDefaultStyle().HasParagraphStyleName() && GetStyleSheet())
2431 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(GetDefaultStyle().GetParagraphStyleName());
2433 defaultParaStyle
= def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(GetStyleSheet());
2436 wxRichTextSplitParaCharStyles(GetDefaultStyle(), defaultParaStyle
, defaultCharStyle
);
2438 wxRichTextAttr
* pStyle
= paraStyle
? paraStyle
: (wxRichTextAttr
*) & defaultParaStyle
;
2439 wxRichTextAttr
* cStyle
= & defaultCharStyle
;
2441 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= new wxRichTextParagraph(this, pStyle
);
2443 para
->AppendChild(new wxRichTextImage(image
, this, cStyle
));
2447 return para
->GetRange();
2451 /// Insert fragment into this box at the given position. If partialParagraph is true,
2452 /// it is assumed that the last (or only) paragraph is just a piece of data with no paragraph
2455 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertFragment(long position
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
& fragment
)
2457 // First, find the first paragraph whose starting position is within the range.
2458 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtPosition(position
);
2461 wxRichTextAttr originalAttr
= para
->GetAttributes();
2463 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.Find(para
);
2465 // Now split at this position, returning the object to insert the new
2466 // ones in front of.
2467 wxRichTextObject
* nextObject
= para
->SplitAt(position
);
2469 // Special case: partial paragraph, just one paragraph. Might be a small amount of
2470 // text, for example, so let's optimize.
2472 if (fragment
.GetPartialParagraph() && fragment
.GetChildren().GetCount() == 1)
2474 // Add the first para to this para...
2475 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator firstParaNode
= fragment
.GetChildren().GetFirst();
2479 // Iterate through the fragment paragraph inserting the content into this paragraph.
2480 wxRichTextParagraph
* firstPara
= wxDynamicCast(firstParaNode
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2481 wxASSERT (firstPara
!= NULL
);
2483 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator objectNode
= firstPara
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
2486 wxRichTextObject
* newObj
= objectNode
->GetData()->Clone();
2491 para
->AppendChild(newObj
);
2495 // Insert before nextObject
2496 para
->InsertChild(newObj
, nextObject
);
2499 objectNode
= objectNode
->GetNext();
2506 // Procedure for inserting a fragment consisting of a number of
2509 // 1. Remove and save the content that's after the insertion point, for adding
2510 // back once we've added the fragment.
2511 // 2. Add the content from the first fragment paragraph to the current
2513 // 3. Add remaining fragment paragraphs after the current paragraph.
2514 // 4. Add back the saved content from the first paragraph. If partialParagraph
2515 // is true, add it to the last paragraph added and not a new one.
2517 // 1. Remove and save objects after split point.
2518 wxList savedObjects
;
2520 para
->MoveToList(nextObject
, savedObjects
);
2522 // 2. Add the content from the 1st fragment paragraph.
2523 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator firstParaNode
= fragment
.GetChildren().GetFirst();
2527 wxRichTextParagraph
* firstPara
= wxDynamicCast(firstParaNode
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2528 wxASSERT(firstPara
!= NULL
);
2530 if (!(fragment
.GetAttributes().GetFlags() & wxTEXT_ATTR_KEEP_FIRST_PARA_STYLE
))
2531 para
->SetAttributes(firstPara
->GetAttributes());
2533 // Save empty paragraph attributes for appending later
2534 // These are character attributes deliberately set for a new paragraph. Without this,
2535 // we couldn't pass default attributes when appending a new paragraph.
2536 wxRichTextAttr emptyParagraphAttributes
;
2538 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator objectNode
= firstPara
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
2540 if (objectNode
&& firstPara
->GetChildren().GetCount() == 1 && objectNode
->GetData()->IsEmpty())
2541 emptyParagraphAttributes
= objectNode
->GetData()->GetAttributes();
2545 wxRichTextObject
* newObj
= objectNode
->GetData()->Clone();
2548 para
->AppendChild(newObj
);
2550 objectNode
= objectNode
->GetNext();
2553 // 3. Add remaining fragment paragraphs after the current paragraph.
2554 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator nextParagraphNode
= node
->GetNext();
2555 wxRichTextObject
* nextParagraph
= NULL
;
2556 if (nextParagraphNode
)
2557 nextParagraph
= nextParagraphNode
->GetData();
2559 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator i
= fragment
.GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetNext();
2560 wxRichTextParagraph
* finalPara
= para
;
2562 bool needExtraPara
= (!i
|| !fragment
.GetPartialParagraph());
2564 // If there was only one paragraph, we need to insert a new one.
2567 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(i
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2568 wxASSERT( para
!= NULL
);
2570 finalPara
= (wxRichTextParagraph
*) para
->Clone();
2573 InsertChild(finalPara
, nextParagraph
);
2575 AppendChild(finalPara
);
2580 // If there was only one paragraph, or we have full paragraphs in our fragment,
2581 // we need to insert a new one.
2584 finalPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph
;
2587 InsertChild(finalPara
, nextParagraph
);
2589 AppendChild(finalPara
);
2592 // 4. Add back the remaining content.
2596 finalPara
->MoveFromList(savedObjects
);
2598 // Ensure there's at least one object
2599 if (finalPara
->GetChildCount() == 0)
2601 wxRichTextPlainText
* text
= new wxRichTextPlainText(wxEmptyString
);
2602 text
->SetAttributes(emptyParagraphAttributes
);
2604 finalPara
->AppendChild(text
);
2608 if ((fragment
.GetAttributes().GetFlags() & wxTEXT_ATTR_KEEP_FIRST_PARA_STYLE
) && firstPara
)
2609 finalPara
->SetAttributes(firstPara
->GetAttributes());
2610 else if (finalPara
&& finalPara
!= para
)
2611 finalPara
->SetAttributes(originalAttr
);
2619 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator i
= fragment
.GetChildren().GetFirst();
2622 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(i
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2623 wxASSERT( para
!= NULL
);
2625 AppendChild(para
->Clone());
2634 /// Make a copy of the fragment corresponding to the given range, putting it in 'fragment'.
2635 /// If there was an incomplete paragraph at the end, partialParagraph is set to true.
2636 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::CopyFragment(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
& fragment
)
2638 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator i
= GetChildren().GetFirst();
2641 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(i
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2642 wxASSERT( para
!= NULL
);
2644 if (!para
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
2646 fragment
.AppendChild(para
->Clone());
2651 // Now top and tail the first and last paragraphs in our new fragment (which might be the same).
2652 if (!fragment
.IsEmpty())
2654 wxRichTextParagraph
* firstPara
= wxDynamicCast(fragment
.GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2655 wxASSERT( firstPara
!= NULL
);
2657 wxRichTextParagraph
* lastPara
= wxDynamicCast(fragment
.GetChildren().GetLast()->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2658 wxASSERT( lastPara
!= NULL
);
2660 if (!firstPara
|| !lastPara
)
2663 bool isFragment
= (range
.GetEnd() < lastPara
->GetRange().GetEnd());
2665 long firstPos
= firstPara
->GetRange().GetStart();
2667 // Adjust for renumbering from zero
2668 wxRichTextRange
topTailRange(range
.GetStart() - firstPos
, range
.GetEnd() - firstPos
);
2671 fragment
.CalculateRange(0, end
);
2673 // Chop off the start of the paragraph
2674 if (topTailRange
.GetStart() > 0)
2676 wxRichTextRange
r(0, topTailRange
.GetStart()-1);
2677 firstPara
->DeleteRange(r
);
2679 // Make sure the numbering is correct
2680 fragment
.CalculateRange(0, end
);
2682 // Now, we've deleted some positions, so adjust the range
2684 topTailRange
.SetStart(range
.GetLength());
2685 topTailRange
.SetEnd(fragment
.GetOwnRange().GetEnd());
2689 topTailRange
.SetStart(range
.GetLength());
2690 topTailRange
.SetEnd(fragment
.GetOwnRange().GetEnd());
2693 if (topTailRange
.GetStart() < (lastPara
->GetRange().GetEnd()-1))
2695 lastPara
->DeleteRange(topTailRange
);
2697 // Make sure the numbering is correct
2699 fragment
.CalculateRange(0, end
);
2701 // We only have part of a paragraph at the end
2702 fragment
.SetPartialParagraph(true);
2706 // We have a partial paragraph (don't save last new paragraph marker)
2707 // or complete paragraph
2708 fragment
.SetPartialParagraph(isFragment
);
2715 /// Given a position, get the number of the visible line (potentially many to a paragraph),
2716 /// starting from zero at the start of the buffer.
2717 long wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetVisibleLineNumber(long pos
, bool caretPosition
, bool startOfLine
) const
2724 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2727 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2728 // wxASSERT( child != NULL );
2732 if (child
->GetRange().Contains(pos
))
2734 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node2
= child
->GetLines().GetFirst();
2737 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node2
->GetData();
2738 wxRichTextRange lineRange
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
2740 if (lineRange
.Contains(pos
) || pos
== lineRange
.GetStart())
2742 // If the caret is displayed at the end of the previous wrapped line,
2743 // we want to return the line it's _displayed_ at (not the actual line
2744 // containing the position).
2745 if (lineRange
.GetStart() == pos
&& !startOfLine
&& child
->GetRange().GetStart() != pos
)
2746 return lineCount
- 1;
2753 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
2755 // If we didn't find it in the lines, it must be
2756 // the last position of the paragraph. So return the last line.
2760 lineCount
+= child
->GetLines().GetCount();
2763 node
= node
->GetNext();
2770 /// Given a line number, get the corresponding wxRichTextLine object.
2771 wxRichTextLine
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetLineForVisibleLineNumber(long lineNumber
) const
2775 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2778 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2779 // wxASSERT(child != NULL);
2783 if (lineNumber
< (int) (child
->GetLines().GetCount() + lineCount
))
2785 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node2
= child
->GetLines().GetFirst();
2788 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node2
->GetData();
2790 if (lineCount
== lineNumber
)
2795 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
2799 lineCount
+= child
->GetLines().GetCount();
2802 node
= node
->GetNext();
2809 /// Delete range from layout.
2810 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::DeleteRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
)
2812 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2814 wxRichTextParagraph
* firstPara
= NULL
;
2817 wxRichTextParagraph
* obj
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2818 // wxASSERT (obj != NULL);
2820 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator next
= node
->GetNext();
2824 // Delete the range in each paragraph
2826 if (!obj
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
2828 // Deletes the content of this object within the given range
2829 obj
->DeleteRange(range
);
2831 wxRichTextRange thisRange
= obj
->GetRange();
2832 wxRichTextAttr thisAttr
= obj
->GetAttributes();
2834 // If the whole paragraph is within the range to delete,
2835 // delete the whole thing.
2836 if (range
.GetStart() <= thisRange
.GetStart() && range
.GetEnd() >= thisRange
.GetEnd())
2838 // Delete the whole object
2839 RemoveChild(obj
, true);
2842 else if (!firstPara
)
2845 // If the range includes the paragraph end, we need to join this
2846 // and the next paragraph.
2847 if (range
.GetEnd() <= thisRange
.GetEnd())
2849 // We need to move the objects from the next paragraph
2850 // to this paragraph
2852 wxRichTextParagraph
* nextParagraph
= NULL
;
2853 if ((range
.GetEnd() < thisRange
.GetEnd()) && obj
)
2854 nextParagraph
= obj
;
2857 // We're ending at the end of the paragraph, so merge the _next_ paragraph.
2859 nextParagraph
= wxDynamicCast(next
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
2862 bool applyFinalParagraphStyle
= firstPara
&& nextParagraph
&& nextParagraph
!= firstPara
;
2864 wxRichTextAttr nextParaAttr
;
2865 if (applyFinalParagraphStyle
)
2867 // Special case when deleting the end of a paragraph - use _this_ paragraph's style,
2868 // not the next one.
2869 if (range
.GetStart() == range
.GetEnd() && range
.GetStart() == thisRange
.GetEnd())
2870 nextParaAttr
= thisAttr
;
2872 nextParaAttr
= nextParagraph
->GetAttributes();
2875 if (firstPara
&& nextParagraph
&& firstPara
!= nextParagraph
)
2877 // Move the objects to the previous para
2878 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node1
= nextParagraph
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
2882 wxRichTextObject
* obj1
= node1
->GetData();
2884 firstPara
->AppendChild(obj1
);
2886 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator next1
= node1
->GetNext();
2887 nextParagraph
->GetChildren().Erase(node1
);
2892 // Delete the paragraph
2893 RemoveChild(nextParagraph
, true);
2896 // Avoid empty paragraphs
2897 if (firstPara
&& firstPara
->GetChildren().GetCount() == 0)
2899 wxRichTextPlainText
* text
= new wxRichTextPlainText(wxEmptyString
);
2900 firstPara
->AppendChild(text
);
2903 if (applyFinalParagraphStyle
)
2904 firstPara
->SetAttributes(nextParaAttr
);
2917 /// Get any text in this object for the given range
2918 wxString
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetTextForRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
) const
2922 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
2925 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
2926 if (!child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
2928 wxRichTextRange childRange
= range
;
2929 childRange
.LimitTo(child
->GetRange());
2931 wxString childText
= child
->GetTextForRange(childRange
);
2935 if ((childRange
.GetEnd() == child
->GetRange().GetEnd()) && node
->GetNext())
2940 node
= node
->GetNext();
2946 /// Get all the text
2947 wxString
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetText() const
2949 return GetTextForRange(GetOwnRange());
2952 /// Get the paragraph by number
2953 wxRichTextParagraph
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetParagraphAtLine(long paragraphNumber
) const
2955 if ((size_t) paragraphNumber
>= GetChildCount())
2958 return (wxRichTextParagraph
*) GetChild((size_t) paragraphNumber
);
2961 /// Get the length of the paragraph
2962 int wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetParagraphLength(long paragraphNumber
) const
2964 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtLine(paragraphNumber
);
2966 return para
->GetRange().GetLength() - 1; // don't include newline
2971 /// Get the text of the paragraph
2972 wxString
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetParagraphText(long paragraphNumber
) const
2974 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtLine(paragraphNumber
);
2976 return para
->GetTextForRange(para
->GetRange());
2978 return wxEmptyString
;
2981 /// Convert zero-based line column and paragraph number to a position.
2982 long wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::XYToPosition(long x
, long y
) const
2984 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtLine(y
);
2987 return para
->GetRange().GetStart() + x
;
2993 /// Convert zero-based position to line column and paragraph number
2994 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::PositionToXY(long pos
, long* x
, long* y
) const
2996 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtPosition(pos
);
3000 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3003 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
3007 node
= node
->GetNext();
3011 *x
= pos
- para
->GetRange().GetStart();
3019 /// Get the leaf object in a paragraph at this position.
3020 /// Given a line number, get the corresponding wxRichTextLine object.
3021 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetLeafObjectAtPosition(long position
) const
3023 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtPosition(position
);
3026 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= para
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
3030 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
3031 if (child
->GetRange().Contains(position
))
3034 node
= node
->GetNext();
3036 if (position
== para
->GetRange().GetEnd() && para
->GetChildCount() > 0)
3037 return para
->GetChildren().GetLast()->GetData();
3042 /// Set character or paragraph text attributes: apply character styles only to immediate text nodes
3043 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::SetStyle(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
, int flags
)
3045 bool characterStyle
= false;
3046 bool paragraphStyle
= false;
3048 if (style
.IsCharacterStyle())
3049 characterStyle
= true;
3050 if (style
.IsParagraphStyle())
3051 paragraphStyle
= true;
3053 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
3055 bool withUndo
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
) != 0);
3056 bool applyMinimal
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_OPTIMIZE
) != 0);
3057 bool parasOnly
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_PARAGRAPHS_ONLY
) != 0);
3058 bool charactersOnly
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_CHARACTERS_ONLY
) != 0);
3059 bool resetExistingStyle
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET
) != 0);
3060 bool removeStyle
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_REMOVE
) != 0);
3062 // Apply paragraph style first, if any
3063 wxRichTextAttr
wholeStyle(style
);
3065 if (!removeStyle
&& wholeStyle
.HasParagraphStyleName() && buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
3067 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(wholeStyle
.GetParagraphStyleName());
3069 wxRichTextApplyStyle(wholeStyle
, def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(buffer
->GetStyleSheet()));
3072 // Limit the attributes to be set to the content to only character attributes.
3073 wxRichTextAttr
characterAttributes(wholeStyle
);
3074 characterAttributes
.SetFlags(characterAttributes
.GetFlags() & (wxTEXT_ATTR_CHARACTER
));
3076 if (!removeStyle
&& characterAttributes
.HasCharacterStyleName() && buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
3078 wxRichTextCharacterStyleDefinition
* def
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindCharacterStyle(characterAttributes
.GetCharacterStyleName());
3080 wxRichTextApplyStyle(characterAttributes
, def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(buffer
->GetStyleSheet()));
3083 // If we are associated with a control, make undoable; otherwise, apply immediately
3086 bool haveControl
= (buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl() != NULL
);
3088 wxRichTextAction
* action
= NULL
;
3090 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3092 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Change Style"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_STYLE
, buffer
, this, buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl());
3093 action
->SetRange(range
);
3094 action
->SetPosition(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetCaretPosition());
3097 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3100 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3101 // wxASSERT (para != NULL);
3103 if (para
&& para
->GetChildCount() > 0)
3105 // Stop searching if we're beyond the range of interest
3106 if (para
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd())
3109 if (!para
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
3111 // We'll be using a copy of the paragraph to make style changes,
3112 // not updating the buffer directly.
3113 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
3115 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3117 newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
);
3118 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
3120 // Also store the old ones for Undo
3121 action
->GetOldParagraphs().AppendChild(new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
));
3126 // If we're specifying paragraphs only, then we really mean character formatting
3127 // to be included in the paragraph style
3128 if ((paragraphStyle
|| parasOnly
) && !charactersOnly
)
3132 // Removes the given style from the paragraph
3133 wxRichTextRemoveStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes(), style
);
3135 else if (resetExistingStyle
)
3136 newPara
->GetAttributes() = wholeStyle
;
3141 // Only apply attributes that will make a difference to the combined
3142 // style as seen on the display
3143 wxRichTextAttr
combinedAttr(para
->GetCombinedAttributes(true));
3144 wxRichTextApplyStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes(), wholeStyle
, & combinedAttr
);
3147 wxRichTextApplyStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes(), wholeStyle
);
3151 // When applying paragraph styles dynamically, don't change the text objects' attributes
3152 // since they will computed as needed. Only apply the character styling if it's _only_
3153 // character styling. This policy is subject to change and might be put under user control.
3155 // Hm. we might well be applying a mix of paragraph and character styles, in which
3156 // case we _do_ want to apply character styles regardless of what para styles are set.
3157 // But if we're applying a paragraph style, which has some character attributes, but
3158 // we only want the paragraphs to hold this character style, then we _don't_ want to
3159 // apply the character style. So we need to be able to choose.
3161 if (!parasOnly
&& (characterStyle
|charactersOnly
) && range
.GetStart() != newPara
->GetRange().GetEnd())
3163 wxRichTextRange
childRange(range
);
3164 childRange
.LimitTo(newPara
->GetRange());
3166 // Find the starting position and if necessary split it so
3167 // we can start applying a different style.
3168 // TODO: check that the style actually changes or is different
3169 // from style outside of range
3170 wxRichTextObject
* firstObject
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
3171 wxRichTextObject
* lastObject
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
3173 if (childRange
.GetStart() == newPara
->GetRange().GetStart())
3174 firstObject
= newPara
->GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData();
3176 firstObject
= newPara
->SplitAt(range
.GetStart());
3178 // Increment by 1 because we're apply the style one _after_ the split point
3179 long splitPoint
= childRange
.GetEnd();
3180 if (splitPoint
!= newPara
->GetRange().GetEnd())
3184 if (splitPoint
== newPara
->GetRange().GetEnd())
3185 lastObject
= newPara
->GetChildren().GetLast()->GetData();
3187 // lastObject is set as a side-effect of splitting. It's
3188 // returned as the object before the new object.
3189 (void) newPara
->SplitAt(splitPoint
, & lastObject
);
3191 wxASSERT(firstObject
!= NULL
);
3192 wxASSERT(lastObject
!= NULL
);
3194 if (!firstObject
|| !lastObject
)
3197 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator firstNode
= newPara
->GetChildren().Find(firstObject
);
3198 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator lastNode
= newPara
->GetChildren().Find(lastObject
);
3200 wxASSERT(firstNode
);
3203 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node2
= firstNode
;
3207 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node2
->GetData();
3211 // Removes the given style from the paragraph
3212 wxRichTextRemoveStyle(child
->GetAttributes(), style
);
3214 else if (resetExistingStyle
)
3215 child
->GetAttributes() = characterAttributes
;
3220 // Only apply attributes that will make a difference to the combined
3221 // style as seen on the display
3222 wxRichTextAttr
combinedAttr(newPara
->GetCombinedAttributes(child
->GetAttributes(), true));
3223 wxRichTextApplyStyle(child
->GetAttributes(), characterAttributes
, & combinedAttr
);
3226 wxRichTextApplyStyle(child
->GetAttributes(), characterAttributes
);
3229 if (node2
== lastNode
)
3232 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
3238 node
= node
->GetNext();
3241 // Do action, or delay it until end of batch.
3242 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3243 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
3248 // Just change the attributes for this single object.
3249 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::SetStyle(wxRichTextObject
* obj
, const wxRichTextAttr
& textAttr
, int flags
)
3251 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
3252 bool withUndo
= flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
;
3253 bool resetExistingStyle
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET
) != 0);
3254 bool haveControl
= (buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl() != NULL
);
3256 wxRichTextAction
*action
= NULL
;
3257 wxRichTextAttr newAttr
= obj
->GetAttributes();
3258 if (resetExistingStyle
)
3261 newAttr
.Apply(textAttr
);
3263 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3265 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Change Object Style"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_ATTRIBUTES
, buffer
, obj
->GetContainer(), buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl());
3266 action
->SetRange(obj
->GetRange().FromInternal());
3267 action
->SetPosition(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetCaretPosition());
3268 action
->MakeObject(obj
);
3270 action
->GetAttributes() = newAttr
;
3273 obj
->GetAttributes() = newAttr
;
3275 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3276 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
3279 /// Get the text attributes for this position.
3280 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetStyle(long position
, wxRichTextAttr
& style
)
3282 return DoGetStyle(position
, style
, true);
3285 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetUncombinedStyle(long position
, wxRichTextAttr
& style
)
3287 return DoGetStyle(position
, style
, false);
3290 /// Implementation helper for GetStyle. If combineStyles is true, combine base, paragraph and
3291 /// context attributes.
3292 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::DoGetStyle(long position
, wxRichTextAttr
& style
, bool combineStyles
)
3294 wxRichTextObject
* obj
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
3296 if (style
.IsParagraphStyle())
3298 obj
= GetParagraphAtPosition(position
);
3303 // Start with the base style
3304 style
= GetAttributes();
3306 // Apply the paragraph style
3307 wxRichTextApplyStyle(style
, obj
->GetAttributes());
3310 style
= obj
->GetAttributes();
3317 obj
= GetLeafObjectAtPosition(position
);
3322 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(obj
->GetParent(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3323 style
= para
? para
->GetCombinedAttributes(obj
->GetAttributes()) : obj
->GetAttributes();
3326 style
= obj
->GetAttributes();
3334 static bool wxHasStyle(long flags
, long style
)
3336 return (flags
& style
) != 0;
3339 /// Combines 'style' with 'currentStyle' for the purpose of summarising the attributes of a range of
3341 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::CollectStyle(wxRichTextAttr
& currentStyle
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
, wxRichTextAttr
& clashingAttr
, wxRichTextAttr
& absentAttr
)
3343 currentStyle
.CollectCommonAttributes(style
, clashingAttr
, absentAttr
);
3348 /// Get the combined style for a range - if any attribute is different within the range,
3349 /// that attribute is not present within the flags.
3350 /// *** Note that this is not recursive, and so assumes that content inside a paragraph is not itself
3352 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetStyleForRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextAttr
& style
)
3354 style
= wxRichTextAttr();
3356 wxRichTextAttr clashingAttr
;
3357 wxRichTextAttr absentAttrPara
, absentAttrChar
;
3359 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= GetChildren().GetFirst();
3362 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3363 if (para
&& !(para
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd() || para
->GetRange().GetEnd() < range
.GetStart()))
3365 if (para
->GetChildren().GetCount() == 0)
3367 wxRichTextAttr paraStyle
= para
->GetCombinedAttributes(true /* use box attributes */);
3369 CollectStyle(style
, paraStyle
, clashingAttr
, absentAttrPara
);
3373 wxRichTextRange
paraRange(para
->GetRange());
3374 paraRange
.LimitTo(range
);
3376 // First collect paragraph attributes only
3377 wxRichTextAttr paraStyle
= para
->GetCombinedAttributes();
3378 paraStyle
.SetFlags(paraStyle
.GetFlags() & wxTEXT_ATTR_PARAGRAPH
);
3379 CollectStyle(style
, paraStyle
, clashingAttr
, absentAttrPara
);
3381 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator childNode
= para
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
3385 wxRichTextObject
* child
= childNode
->GetData();
3386 if (!(child
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd() || child
->GetRange().GetEnd() < range
.GetStart()))
3388 wxRichTextAttr childStyle
= para
->GetCombinedAttributes(child
->GetAttributes(), true /* include box attributes */);
3390 // Now collect character attributes only
3391 childStyle
.SetFlags(childStyle
.GetFlags() & wxTEXT_ATTR_CHARACTER
);
3393 CollectStyle(style
, childStyle
, clashingAttr
, absentAttrChar
);
3396 childNode
= childNode
->GetNext();
3400 node
= node
->GetNext();
3405 /// Set default style
3406 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::SetDefaultStyle(const wxRichTextAttr
& style
)
3408 m_defaultAttributes
= style
;
3412 /// Test if this whole range has character attributes of the specified kind. If any
3413 /// of the attributes are different within the range, the test fails. You
3414 /// can use this to implement, for example, bold button updating. style must have
3415 /// flags indicating which attributes are of interest.
3416 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::HasCharacterAttributes(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
) const
3419 int matchingCount
= 0;
3421 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3424 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3425 // wxASSERT (para != NULL);
3429 // Stop searching if we're beyond the range of interest
3430 if (para
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd())
3431 return foundCount
== matchingCount
&& foundCount
!= 0;
3433 if (!para
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
3435 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node2
= para
->GetChildren().GetFirst();
3439 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node2
->GetData();
3440 // Allow for empty string if no buffer
3441 wxRichTextRange childRange
= child
->GetRange();
3442 if (childRange
.GetLength() == 0 && GetRange().GetLength() == 1)
3443 childRange
.SetEnd(childRange
.GetEnd()+1);
3445 if (!childRange
.IsOutside(range
) && child
->IsKindOf(CLASSINFO(wxRichTextPlainText
)))
3448 wxRichTextAttr textAttr
= para
->GetCombinedAttributes(child
->GetAttributes());
3450 if (wxTextAttrEqPartial(textAttr
, style
))
3454 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
3459 node
= node
->GetNext();
3462 return foundCount
== matchingCount
&& foundCount
!= 0;
3465 /// Test if this whole range has paragraph attributes of the specified kind. If any
3466 /// of the attributes are different within the range, the test fails. You
3467 /// can use this to implement, for example, centering button updating. style must have
3468 /// flags indicating which attributes are of interest.
3469 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::HasParagraphAttributes(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
) const
3472 int matchingCount
= 0;
3474 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3477 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3478 // wxASSERT (para != NULL);
3482 // Stop searching if we're beyond the range of interest
3483 if (para
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd())
3484 return foundCount
== matchingCount
&& foundCount
!= 0;
3486 if (!para
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
3488 wxRichTextAttr textAttr
= GetAttributes();
3489 // Apply the paragraph style
3490 wxRichTextApplyStyle(textAttr
, para
->GetAttributes());
3493 if (wxTextAttrEqPartial(textAttr
, style
))
3498 node
= node
->GetNext();
3500 return foundCount
== matchingCount
&& foundCount
!= 0;
3503 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Reset()
3507 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
3508 if (buffer
&& buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl())
3510 wxRichTextEvent
event(wxEVT_COMMAND_RICHTEXT_BUFFER_RESET
, buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetId());
3511 event
.SetEventObject(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl());
3512 event
.SetContainer(this);
3514 buffer
->SendEvent(event
, true);
3517 AddParagraph(wxEmptyString
);
3519 InvalidateHierarchy(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
3522 /// Invalidate the buffer. With no argument, invalidates whole buffer.
3523 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Invalidate(const wxRichTextRange
& invalidRange
)
3525 wxRichTextCompositeObject::Invalidate(invalidRange
);
3527 DoInvalidate(invalidRange
);
3530 // Do the (in)validation for this object only
3531 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::DoInvalidate(const wxRichTextRange
& invalidRange
)
3533 if (invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_ALL
)
3535 m_invalidRange
= wxRICHTEXT_ALL
;
3537 // Already invalidating everything
3538 else if (m_invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_ALL
)
3543 if ((invalidRange
.GetStart() < m_invalidRange
.GetStart()) || m_invalidRange
.GetStart() == -1)
3544 m_invalidRange
.SetStart(invalidRange
.GetStart());
3545 if (invalidRange
.GetEnd() > m_invalidRange
.GetEnd())
3546 m_invalidRange
.SetEnd(invalidRange
.GetEnd());
3550 // Do the (in)validation both up and down the hierarchy
3551 void wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InvalidateHierarchy(const wxRichTextRange
& invalidRange
)
3553 Invalidate(invalidRange
);
3555 if (invalidRange
!= wxRICHTEXT_NONE
)
3557 // Now go up the hierarchy
3558 wxRichTextObject
* thisObj
= this;
3559 wxRichTextObject
* p
= GetParent();
3562 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* l
= wxDynamicCast(p
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
);
3564 l
->DoInvalidate(thisObj
->GetRange());
3572 /// Get invalid range, rounding to entire paragraphs if argument is true.
3573 wxRichTextRange
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetInvalidRange(bool wholeParagraphs
) const
3575 if (m_invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_ALL
|| m_invalidRange
== wxRICHTEXT_NONE
)
3576 return m_invalidRange
;
3578 wxRichTextRange range
= m_invalidRange
;
3580 if (wholeParagraphs
)
3582 wxRichTextParagraph
* para1
= GetParagraphAtPosition(range
.GetStart());
3584 range
.SetStart(para1
->GetRange().GetStart());
3585 // floating layout make all child should be relayout
3586 range
.SetEnd(GetOwnRange().GetEnd());
3591 /// Apply the style sheet to the buffer, for example if the styles have changed.
3592 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::ApplyStyleSheet(wxRichTextStyleSheet
* styleSheet
)
3594 wxASSERT(styleSheet
!= NULL
);
3600 wxRichTextAttr
attr(GetBasicStyle());
3601 if (GetBasicStyle().HasParagraphStyleName())
3603 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* paraDef
= styleSheet
->FindParagraphStyle(GetBasicStyle().GetParagraphStyleName());
3606 attr
.Apply(paraDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
));
3607 SetBasicStyle(attr
);
3612 if (GetBasicStyle().HasCharacterStyleName())
3614 wxRichTextCharacterStyleDefinition
* charDef
= styleSheet
->FindCharacterStyle(GetBasicStyle().GetCharacterStyleName());
3617 attr
.Apply(charDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
));
3618 SetBasicStyle(attr
);
3623 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3626 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3627 // wxASSERT (para != NULL);
3631 // Combine paragraph and list styles. If there is a list style in the original attributes,
3632 // the current indentation overrides anything else and is used to find the item indentation.
3633 // Also, for applying paragraph styles, consider having 2 modes: (1) we merge with what we have,
3634 // thereby taking into account all user changes, (2) reset the style completely (except for indentation/list
3635 // exception as above).
3636 // Problem: when changing from one list style to another, there's a danger that the level info will get lost.
3637 // So when changing a list style interactively, could retrieve level based on current style, then
3638 // set appropriate indent and apply new style.
3642 if (para
->GetAttributes().HasOutlineLevel())
3643 outline
= para
->GetAttributes().GetOutlineLevel();
3644 if (para
->GetAttributes().HasBulletNumber())
3645 num
= para
->GetAttributes().GetBulletNumber();
3647 if (!para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName().IsEmpty() && !para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty())
3649 int currentIndent
= para
->GetAttributes().GetLeftIndent();
3651 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* paraDef
= styleSheet
->FindParagraphStyle(para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName());
3652 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* listDef
= styleSheet
->FindListStyle(para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName());
3653 if (paraDef
&& !listDef
)
3655 para
->GetAttributes() = paraDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
);
3658 else if (listDef
&& !paraDef
)
3660 // Set overall style defined for the list style definition
3661 para
->GetAttributes() = listDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
);
3663 // Apply the style for this level
3664 wxRichTextApplyStyle(para
->GetAttributes(), * listDef
->GetLevelAttributes(listDef
->FindLevelForIndent(currentIndent
)));
3667 else if (listDef
&& paraDef
)
3669 // Combines overall list style, style for level, and paragraph style
3670 para
->GetAttributes() = listDef
->CombineWithParagraphStyle(currentIndent
, paraDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
));
3674 else if (para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName().IsEmpty() && !para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty())
3676 int currentIndent
= para
->GetAttributes().GetLeftIndent();
3678 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* listDef
= styleSheet
->FindListStyle(para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName());
3680 // Overall list definition style
3681 para
->GetAttributes() = listDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
);
3683 // Style for this level
3684 wxRichTextApplyStyle(para
->GetAttributes(), * listDef
->GetLevelAttributes(listDef
->FindLevelForIndent(currentIndent
)));
3688 else if (!para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName().IsEmpty() && para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty())
3690 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= styleSheet
->FindParagraphStyle(para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName());
3693 para
->GetAttributes() = def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
);
3699 para
->GetAttributes().SetOutlineLevel(outline
);
3701 para
->GetAttributes().SetBulletNumber(num
);
3704 node
= node
->GetNext();
3706 return foundCount
!= 0;
3710 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::SetListStyle(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
, int flags
, int startFrom
, int specifiedLevel
)
3712 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
3713 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* styleSheet
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet();
3715 bool withUndo
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
) != 0);
3716 // bool applyMinimal = ((flags & wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_OPTIMIZE) != 0);
3717 bool specifyLevel
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_SPECIFY_LEVEL
) != 0);
3718 bool renumber
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RENUMBER
) != 0);
3720 // Current number, if numbering
3723 wxASSERT (!specifyLevel
|| (specifyLevel
&& (specifiedLevel
>= 0)));
3725 // If we are associated with a control, make undoable; otherwise, apply immediately
3728 bool haveControl
= (buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl() != NULL
);
3730 wxRichTextAction
* action
= NULL
;
3732 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3734 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Change List Style"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_STYLE
, buffer
, this, buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl());
3735 action
->SetRange(range
);
3736 action
->SetPosition(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetCaretPosition());
3739 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3742 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3743 // wxASSERT (para != NULL);
3745 if (para
&& para
->GetChildCount() > 0)
3747 // Stop searching if we're beyond the range of interest
3748 if (para
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd())
3751 if (!para
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
3753 // We'll be using a copy of the paragraph to make style changes,
3754 // not updating the buffer directly.
3755 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
3757 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3759 newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
);
3760 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
3762 // Also store the old ones for Undo
3763 action
->GetOldParagraphs().AppendChild(new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
));
3770 int thisIndent
= newPara
->GetAttributes().GetLeftIndent();
3771 int thisLevel
= specifyLevel
? specifiedLevel
: def
->FindLevelForIndent(thisIndent
);
3773 // How is numbering going to work?
3774 // If we are renumbering, or numbering for the first time, we need to keep
3775 // track of the number for each level. But we might be simply applying a different
3777 // In Word, applying a style to several paragraphs, even if at different levels,
3778 // reverts the level back to the same one. So we could do the same here.
3779 // Renumbering will need to be done when we promote/demote a paragraph.
3781 // Apply the overall list style, and item style for this level
3782 wxRichTextAttr
listStyle(def
->GetCombinedStyleForLevel(thisLevel
, styleSheet
));
3783 wxRichTextApplyStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes(), listStyle
);
3785 // Now we need to do numbering
3788 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetBulletNumber(n
);
3793 else if (!newPara
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty())
3795 // if def is NULL, remove list style, applying any associated paragraph style
3796 // to restore the attributes
3798 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetListStyleName(wxEmptyString
);
3799 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetLeftIndent(0, 0);
3800 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetBulletText(wxEmptyString
);
3802 // Eliminate the main list-related attributes
3803 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetFlags(newPara
->GetAttributes().GetFlags() & ~wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
& ~wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
& ~wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NUMBER
& ~wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_TEXT
& wxTEXT_ATTR_LIST_STYLE_NAME
);
3805 if (styleSheet
&& !newPara
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName().IsEmpty())
3807 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= styleSheet
->FindParagraphStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName());
3810 newPara
->GetAttributes() = def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(styleSheet
);
3817 node
= node
->GetNext();
3820 // Do action, or delay it until end of batch.
3821 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3822 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
3827 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::SetListStyle(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxString
& defName
, int flags
, int startFrom
, int specifiedLevel
)
3829 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
3830 if (buffer
&& buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
3832 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindListStyle(defName
);
3834 return SetListStyle(range
, def
, flags
, startFrom
, specifiedLevel
);
3839 /// Clear list for given range
3840 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::ClearListStyle(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, int flags
)
3842 return SetListStyle(range
, NULL
, flags
);
3845 /// Number/renumber any list elements in the given range
3846 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::NumberList(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
, int flags
, int startFrom
, int specifiedLevel
)
3848 return DoNumberList(range
, range
, 0, def
, flags
, startFrom
, specifiedLevel
);
3851 /// Number/renumber any list elements in the given range. Also do promotion or demotion of items, if specified
3852 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::DoNumberList(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextRange
& promotionRange
, int promoteBy
,
3853 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
, int flags
, int startFrom
, int specifiedLevel
)
3855 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
3856 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* styleSheet
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet();
3858 bool withUndo
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
) != 0);
3859 // bool applyMinimal = ((flags & wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_OPTIMIZE) != 0);
3861 bool specifyLevel
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_SPECIFY_LEVEL
) != 0);
3864 bool renumber
= ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RENUMBER
) != 0);
3866 // Max number of levels
3867 const int maxLevels
= 10;
3869 // The level we're looking at now
3870 int currentLevel
= -1;
3872 // The item number for each level
3873 int levels
[maxLevels
];
3876 // Reset all numbering
3877 for (i
= 0; i
< maxLevels
; i
++)
3879 if (startFrom
!= -1)
3880 levels
[i
] = startFrom
-1;
3881 else if (renumber
) // start again
3884 levels
[i
] = -1; // start from the number we found, if any
3887 wxASSERT(!specifyLevel
|| (specifyLevel
&& (specifiedLevel
>= 0)));
3889 // If we are associated with a control, make undoable; otherwise, apply immediately
3892 bool haveControl
= (buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl() != NULL
);
3894 wxRichTextAction
* action
= NULL
;
3896 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3898 action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Renumber List"), wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_STYLE
, buffer
, this, buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl());
3899 action
->SetRange(range
);
3900 action
->SetPosition(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetCaretPosition());
3903 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
3906 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
3907 // wxASSERT (para != NULL);
3909 if (para
&& para
->GetChildCount() > 0)
3911 // Stop searching if we're beyond the range of interest
3912 if (para
->GetRange().GetStart() > range
.GetEnd())
3915 if (!para
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
3917 // We'll be using a copy of the paragraph to make style changes,
3918 // not updating the buffer directly.
3919 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(NULL
);
3921 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
3923 newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
);
3924 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
3926 // Also store the old ones for Undo
3927 action
->GetOldParagraphs().AppendChild(new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
));
3932 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* defToUse
= def
;
3935 if (styleSheet
&& !newPara
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty())
3936 defToUse
= styleSheet
->FindListStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName());
3941 int thisIndent
= newPara
->GetAttributes().GetLeftIndent();
3942 int thisLevel
= defToUse
->FindLevelForIndent(thisIndent
);
3944 // If we've specified a level to apply to all, change the level.
3945 if (specifiedLevel
!= -1)
3946 thisLevel
= specifiedLevel
;
3948 // Do promotion if specified
3949 if ((promoteBy
!= 0) && !para
->GetRange().IsOutside(promotionRange
))
3951 thisLevel
= thisLevel
- promoteBy
;
3958 // Apply the overall list style, and item style for this level
3959 wxRichTextAttr
listStyle(defToUse
->GetCombinedStyleForLevel(thisLevel
, styleSheet
));
3960 wxRichTextApplyStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes(), listStyle
);
3962 // OK, we've (re)applied the style, now let's get the numbering right.
3964 if (currentLevel
== -1)
3965 currentLevel
= thisLevel
;
3967 // Same level as before, do nothing except increment level's number afterwards
3968 if (currentLevel
== thisLevel
)
3971 // A deeper level: start renumbering all levels after current level
3972 else if (thisLevel
> currentLevel
)
3974 for (i
= currentLevel
+1; i
<= thisLevel
; i
++)
3978 currentLevel
= thisLevel
;
3980 else if (thisLevel
< currentLevel
)
3982 currentLevel
= thisLevel
;
3985 // Use the current numbering if -1 and we have a bullet number already
3986 if (levels
[currentLevel
] == -1)
3988 if (newPara
->GetAttributes().HasBulletNumber())
3989 levels
[currentLevel
] = newPara
->GetAttributes().GetBulletNumber();
3991 levels
[currentLevel
] = 1;
3995 levels
[currentLevel
] ++;
3998 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetBulletNumber(levels
[currentLevel
]);
4000 // Create the bullet text if an outline list
4001 if (listStyle
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_OUTLINE
)
4004 for (i
= 0; i
<= currentLevel
; i
++)
4006 if (!text
.IsEmpty())
4008 text
+= wxString::Format(wxT("%d"), levels
[i
]);
4010 newPara
->GetAttributes().SetBulletText(text
);
4016 node
= node
->GetNext();
4019 // Do action, or delay it until end of batch.
4020 if (haveControl
&& withUndo
)
4021 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
4026 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::NumberList(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxString
& defName
, int flags
, int startFrom
, int specifiedLevel
)
4028 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
4029 if (buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
4031 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
= NULL
;
4032 if (!defName
.IsEmpty())
4033 def
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindListStyle(defName
);
4034 return NumberList(range
, def
, flags
, startFrom
, specifiedLevel
);
4039 /// Promote the list items within the given range. promoteBy can be a positive or negative number, e.g. 1 or -1
4040 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::PromoteList(int promoteBy
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
, int flags
, int specifiedLevel
)
4043 // One strategy is to first work out the range within which renumbering must occur. Then could pass these two ranges
4044 // to NumberList with a flag indicating promotion is required within one of the ranges.
4045 // Find first and last paragraphs in range. Then for first, calculate new indentation and look back until we find
4046 // a paragraph that either has no list style, or has one that is different or whose indentation is less.
4047 // We start renumbering from the para after that different para we found. We specify that the numbering of that
4048 // list position will start from 1.
4049 // Similarly, we look after the last para in the promote range for an indentation that is less (or no list style).
4050 // We can end the renumbering at this point.
4052 // For now, only renumber within the promotion range.
4054 return DoNumberList(range
, range
, promoteBy
, def
, flags
, 1, specifiedLevel
);
4057 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::PromoteList(int promoteBy
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxString
& defName
, int flags
, int specifiedLevel
)
4059 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
4060 if (buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
4062 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
= NULL
;
4063 if (!defName
.IsEmpty())
4064 def
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindListStyle(defName
);
4065 return PromoteList(promoteBy
, range
, def
, flags
, specifiedLevel
);
4070 /// Fills in the attributes for numbering a paragraph after previousParagraph. It also finds the
4071 /// position of the paragraph that it had to start looking from.
4072 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::FindNextParagraphNumber(wxRichTextParagraph
* previousParagraph
, wxRichTextAttr
& attr
) const
4074 if (!previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().HasFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
) || previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() == wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_NONE
)
4077 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
4078 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* styleSheet
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet();
4079 if (styleSheet
&& !previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty())
4081 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
= styleSheet
->FindListStyle(previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName());
4084 // int thisIndent = previousParagraph->GetAttributes().GetLeftIndent();
4085 // int thisLevel = def->FindLevelForIndent(thisIndent);
4087 bool isOutline
= (previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_OUTLINE
) != 0;
4089 attr
.SetFlags(previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetFlags() & (wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
|wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NUMBER
|wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_TEXT
|wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NAME
));
4090 if (previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().HasBulletName())
4091 attr
.SetBulletName(previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetBulletName());
4092 attr
.SetBulletStyle(previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle());
4093 attr
.SetListStyleName(previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName());
4095 int nextNumber
= previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetBulletNumber() + 1;
4096 attr
.SetBulletNumber(nextNumber
);
4100 wxString text
= previousParagraph
->GetAttributes().GetBulletText();
4101 if (!text
.IsEmpty())
4103 int pos
= text
.Find(wxT('.'), true);
4104 if (pos
!= wxNOT_FOUND
)
4106 text
= text
.Mid(0, text
.Length() - pos
- 1);
4109 text
= wxEmptyString
;
4110 if (!text
.IsEmpty())
4112 text
+= wxString::Format(wxT("%d"), nextNumber
);
4113 attr
.SetBulletText(text
);
4127 * wxRichTextParagraph
4128 * This object represents a single paragraph (or in a straight text editor, a line).
4131 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextParagraph
, wxRichTextCompositeObject
)
4133 wxArrayInt
wxRichTextParagraph::sm_defaultTabs
;
4135 wxRichTextParagraph::wxRichTextParagraph(wxRichTextObject
* parent
, wxRichTextAttr
* style
):
4136 wxRichTextCompositeObject(parent
)
4139 SetAttributes(*style
);
4142 wxRichTextParagraph::wxRichTextParagraph(const wxString
& text
, wxRichTextObject
* parent
, wxRichTextAttr
* paraStyle
, wxRichTextAttr
* charStyle
):
4143 wxRichTextCompositeObject(parent
)
4146 SetAttributes(*paraStyle
);
4148 AppendChild(new wxRichTextPlainText(text
, this, charStyle
));
4151 wxRichTextParagraph::~wxRichTextParagraph()
4157 bool wxRichTextParagraph::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int WXUNUSED(descent
), int style
)
4162 // Currently we don't merge these attributes with the parent, but we
4163 // should consider whether we should (e.g. if we set a border colour
4164 // for all paragraphs). But generally box attributes are likely to be
4165 // different for different objects.
4166 wxRect paraRect
= GetRect();
4167 DrawBoxAttributes(dc
, GetBuffer(), GetAttributes(), paraRect
);
4169 wxRichTextAttr attr
= GetCombinedAttributes();
4171 // Draw the bullet, if any
4172 if (attr
.GetBulletStyle() != wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_NONE
)
4174 if (attr
.GetLeftSubIndent() != 0)
4176 int spaceBeforePara
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetParagraphSpacingBefore());
4177 int leftIndent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetLeftIndent());
4179 wxRichTextAttr
bulletAttr(GetCombinedAttributes());
4181 // Combine with the font of the first piece of content, if one is specified
4182 if (GetChildren().GetCount() > 0)
4184 wxRichTextObject
* firstObj
= (wxRichTextObject
*) GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData();
4185 if (!firstObj
->IsFloatable() && firstObj
->GetAttributes().HasFont())
4187 wxRichTextApplyStyle(bulletAttr
, firstObj
->GetAttributes());
4191 // Get line height from first line, if any
4192 wxRichTextLine
* line
= m_cachedLines
.GetFirst() ? (wxRichTextLine
* ) m_cachedLines
.GetFirst()->GetData() : NULL
;
4195 int lineHeight
wxDUMMY_INITIALIZE(0);
4198 lineHeight
= line
->GetSize().y
;
4199 linePos
= line
->GetPosition() + GetPosition();
4204 if (bulletAttr
.HasFont() && GetBuffer())
4205 font
= GetBuffer()->GetFontTable().FindFont(bulletAttr
);
4207 font
= (*wxNORMAL_FONT
);
4209 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, font
);
4211 lineHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
4212 linePos
= GetPosition();
4213 linePos
.y
+= spaceBeforePara
;
4216 wxRect
bulletRect(GetPosition().x
+ leftIndent
, linePos
.y
, linePos
.x
- (GetPosition().x
+ leftIndent
), lineHeight
);
4218 if (attr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_BITMAP
)
4220 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetRenderer())
4221 wxRichTextBuffer::GetRenderer()->DrawBitmapBullet(this, dc
, bulletAttr
, bulletRect
);
4223 else if (attr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_STANDARD
)
4225 if (wxRichTextBuffer::GetRenderer())
4226 wxRichTextBuffer::GetRenderer()->DrawStandardBullet(this, dc
, bulletAttr
, bulletRect
);
4230 wxString bulletText
= GetBulletText();
4232 if (!bulletText
.empty() && wxRichTextBuffer::GetRenderer())
4233 wxRichTextBuffer::GetRenderer()->DrawTextBullet(this, dc
, bulletAttr
, bulletRect
, bulletText
);
4238 // Draw the range for each line, one object at a time.
4240 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_cachedLines
.GetFirst();
4243 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node
->GetData();
4244 wxRichTextRange lineRange
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
4246 // Lines are specified relative to the paragraph
4248 wxPoint linePosition
= line
->GetPosition() + GetPosition();
4250 // Don't draw if off the screen
4251 if (((style
& wxRICHTEXT_DRAW_IGNORE_CACHE
) != 0) || ((linePosition
.y
+ line
->GetSize().y
) >= rect
.y
&& linePosition
.y
<= rect
.y
+ rect
.height
))
4253 wxPoint objectPosition
= linePosition
;
4254 int maxDescent
= line
->GetDescent();
4256 // Loop through objects until we get to the one within range
4257 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node2
= m_children
.GetFirst();
4262 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node2
->GetData();
4264 if (!child
->IsFloating() && child
->GetRange().GetLength() > 0 && !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(lineRange
) && !lineRange
.IsOutside(range
))
4266 // Draw this part of the line at the correct position
4267 wxRichTextRange
objectRange(child
->GetRange());
4268 objectRange
.LimitTo(lineRange
);
4271 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
4273 objectSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
4274 objectRange
= child
->GetOwnRange();
4278 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_LINE_DRAWING && wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
4279 if (i
< (int) line
->GetObjectSizes().GetCount())
4281 objectSize
.x
= line
->GetObjectSizes()[(size_t) i
];
4287 child
->GetRangeSize(objectRange
, objectSize
, descent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
, objectPosition
);
4291 // Use the child object's width, but the whole line's height
4292 wxRect
childRect(objectPosition
, wxSize(objectSize
.x
, line
->GetSize().y
));
4293 child
->Draw(dc
, objectRange
, selection
, childRect
, maxDescent
, style
);
4295 objectPosition
.x
+= objectSize
.x
;
4298 else if (child
->GetRange().GetStart() > lineRange
.GetEnd())
4299 // Can break out of inner loop now since we've passed this line's range
4302 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
4306 node
= node
->GetNext();
4312 // Get the range width using partial extents calculated for the whole paragraph.
4313 static int wxRichTextGetRangeWidth(const wxRichTextParagraph
& para
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxArrayInt
& partialExtents
)
4315 wxASSERT(partialExtents
.GetCount() >= (size_t) range
.GetLength());
4317 if (partialExtents
.GetCount() < (size_t) range
.GetLength())
4320 int leftMostPos
= 0;
4321 if (range
.GetStart() - para
.GetRange().GetStart() > 0)
4322 leftMostPos
= partialExtents
[range
.GetStart() - para
.GetRange().GetStart() - 1];
4324 int rightMostPos
= partialExtents
[range
.GetEnd() - para
.GetRange().GetStart()];
4326 int w
= rightMostPos
- leftMostPos
;
4331 /// Lay the item out
4332 bool wxRichTextParagraph::Layout(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRect
& rect
, int style
)
4334 // Deal with floating objects firstly before the normal layout
4335 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
4337 wxRichTextFloatCollector
* collector
= GetContainer()->GetFloatCollector();
4338 wxASSERT(collector
);
4339 LayoutFloat(dc
, rect
, style
, collector
);
4341 wxRichTextAttr attr
= GetCombinedAttributes();
4345 // Increase the size of the paragraph due to spacing
4346 int spaceBeforePara
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetParagraphSpacingBefore());
4347 int spaceAfterPara
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetParagraphSpacingAfter());
4348 int leftIndent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetLeftIndent());
4349 int leftSubIndent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetLeftSubIndent());
4350 int rightIndent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetRightIndent());
4352 int lineSpacing
= 0;
4354 // Let's assume line spacing of 10 is normal, 15 is 1.5, 20 is 2, etc.
4355 if (attr
.HasLineSpacing() && attr
.GetLineSpacing() > 0 && attr
.GetFont().IsOk())
4357 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, attr
.GetFont());
4358 lineSpacing
= (int) (double(dc
.GetCharHeight()) * (double(attr
.GetLineSpacing())/10.0 - 1.0));
4361 // Start position for each line relative to the paragraph
4362 int startPositionFirstLine
= leftIndent
;
4363 int startPositionSubsequentLines
= leftIndent
+ leftSubIndent
;
4365 // If we have a bullet in this paragraph, the start position for the first line's text
4366 // is actually leftIndent + leftSubIndent.
4367 if (attr
.GetBulletStyle() != wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_NONE
)
4368 startPositionFirstLine
= startPositionSubsequentLines
;
4370 long lastEndPos
= GetRange().GetStart()-1;
4371 long lastCompletedEndPos
= lastEndPos
;
4373 int currentWidth
= 0;
4374 SetPosition(rect
.GetPosition());
4376 wxPoint
currentPosition(0, spaceBeforePara
); // We will calculate lines relative to paragraph
4379 int maxHeight
= currentPosition
.y
;
4384 int lineDescent
= 0;
4386 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
;
4388 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
4390 wxArrayInt partialExtents
;
4393 int paraDescent
= 0;
4395 // This calculates the partial text extents
4396 GetRangeSize(GetRange(), paraSize
, paraDescent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
|wxRICHTEXT_CACHE_SIZE
, rect
.GetPosition(), & partialExtents
);
4398 node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
4401 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
4403 //child->SetCachedSize(wxDefaultSize);
4404 child
->Layout(dc
, rect
, style
);
4406 node
= node
->GetNext();
4413 // We may need to go back to a previous child, in which case create the new line,
4414 // find the child corresponding to the start position of the string, and
4417 wxRect availableRect
;
4419 node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
4422 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
4424 // If floating, ignore. We already laid out floats.
4425 // Also ignore if empty object, except if we haven't got any
4427 if (child
->IsFloating() || !child
->IsShown() ||
4428 (child
->GetRange().GetLength() == 0 && maxHeight
> spaceBeforePara
)
4431 node
= node
->GetNext();
4435 // If this is e.g. a composite text box, it will need to be laid out itself.
4436 // But if just a text fragment or image, for example, this will
4437 // do nothing. NB: won't we need to set the position after layout?
4438 // since for example if position is dependent on vertical line size, we
4439 // can't tell the position until the size is determined. So possibly introduce
4440 // another layout phase.
4442 // We may only be looking at part of a child, if we searched back for wrapping
4443 // and found a suitable point some way into the child. So get the size for the fragment
4446 long nextBreakPos
= GetFirstLineBreakPosition(lastEndPos
+1);
4447 long lastPosToUse
= child
->GetRange().GetEnd();
4448 bool lineBreakInThisObject
= (nextBreakPos
> -1 && nextBreakPos
<= child
->GetRange().GetEnd());
4450 if (lineBreakInThisObject
)
4451 lastPosToUse
= nextBreakPos
;
4454 int childDescent
= 0;
4456 int startOffset
= (lineCount
== 0 ? startPositionFirstLine
: startPositionSubsequentLines
);
4457 availableRect
= wxRect(rect
.x
+ startOffset
, rect
.y
+ currentPosition
.y
,
4458 rect
.width
- startOffset
- rightIndent
, rect
.height
);
4460 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
4462 wxSize oldSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
4464 child
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
4465 child
->SetPosition(wxPoint(0, 0));
4467 // Lays out the object first with a given amount of space, and then if no width was specified in attr,
4468 // lays out the object again using the minimum size
4469 // The position will be determined by its location in its line,
4470 // and not by the child's actual position.
4471 child
->LayoutToBestSize(dc
, buffer
,
4472 GetAttributes(), child
->GetAttributes(), availableRect
, style
);
4474 if (oldSize
!= child
->GetCachedSize())
4476 partialExtents
.Clear();
4478 // Recalculate the partial text extents since the child object changed size
4479 GetRangeSize(GetRange(), paraSize
, paraDescent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
|wxRICHTEXT_CACHE_SIZE
, wxPoint(0,0), & partialExtents
);
4483 // Problem: we need to layout composites here for which we need the available width,
4484 // but we can't get the available width without using the float collector which
4485 // needs to know the object height.
4487 if ((nextBreakPos
== -1) && (lastEndPos
== child
->GetRange().GetStart() - 1)) // i.e. we want to get the whole thing
4489 childSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
4490 childDescent
= child
->GetDescent();
4494 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
4495 // Get height only, then the width using the partial extents
4496 GetRangeSize(wxRichTextRange(lastEndPos
+1, lastPosToUse
), childSize
, childDescent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
|wxRICHTEXT_HEIGHT_ONLY
);
4497 childSize
.x
= wxRichTextGetRangeWidth(*this, wxRichTextRange(lastEndPos
+1, lastPosToUse
), partialExtents
);
4499 GetRangeSize(wxRichTextRange(lastEndPos
+1, lastPosToUse
), childSize
, childDescent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
, rect
.GetPosition());
4504 int loopIterations
= 0;
4506 // If there are nested objects that need to lay themselves out, we have to do this in a
4507 // loop because the height of the object may well depend on the available width.
4508 // And because of floating object positioning, the available width depends on the
4509 // height of the object and whether it will clash with the floating objects.
4510 // So, we see whether the available width changes due to the presence of floating images.
4511 // If it does, then we'll use the new restricted width to find the object height again.
4512 // If this causes another restriction in the available width, we'll try again, until
4513 // either we lose patience or the available width settles down.
4518 wxRect oldAvailableRect
= availableRect
;
4520 // Available width depends on the floating objects and the line height.
4521 // Note: the floating objects may be placed vertically along the two side of
4522 // buffer, so we may have different available line widths with different
4523 // [startY, endY]. So, we can't determine how wide the available
4524 // space is until we know the exact line height.
4525 lineDescent
= wxMax(childDescent
, maxDescent
);
4526 lineAscent
= wxMax(childSize
.y
-childDescent
, maxAscent
);
4527 lineHeight
= lineDescent
+ lineAscent
;
4528 wxRect floatAvailableRect
= collector
->GetAvailableRect(rect
.y
+ currentPosition
.y
, rect
.y
+ currentPosition
.y
+ lineHeight
);
4530 // Adjust availableRect to the space that is available when taking floating objects into account.
4532 if (floatAvailableRect
.x
+ startOffset
> availableRect
.x
)
4534 int newX
= floatAvailableRect
.x
+ startOffset
;
4535 int newW
= availableRect
.width
- (newX
- availableRect
.x
);
4536 availableRect
.x
= newX
;
4537 availableRect
.width
= newW
;
4540 if (floatAvailableRect
.width
< availableRect
.width
)
4541 availableRect
.width
= floatAvailableRect
.width
;
4543 currentPosition
.x
= availableRect
.x
- rect
.x
;
4545 if (child
->IsTopLevel() && loopIterations
<= 20)
4547 if (availableRect
!= oldAvailableRect
)
4549 wxSize oldSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
4551 //child->SetCachedSize(wxDefaultSize);
4552 // Lays out the object first with a given amount of space, and then if no width was specified in attr,
4553 // lays out the object again using the minimum size
4554 child
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
4555 child
->LayoutToBestSize(dc
, buffer
,
4556 GetAttributes(), child
->GetAttributes(), availableRect
, style
);
4557 childSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
4558 childDescent
= child
->GetDescent();
4559 //child->SetPosition(availableRect.GetPosition());
4561 if (oldSize
!= child
->GetCachedSize())
4563 partialExtents
.Clear();
4565 // Recalculate the partial text extents since the child object changed size
4566 GetRangeSize(GetRange(), paraSize
, paraDescent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
|wxRICHTEXT_CACHE_SIZE
, wxPoint(0,0), & partialExtents
);
4569 // Go around the loop finding the available rect for the given floating objects
4580 // 1) There was a line break BEFORE the natural break
4581 // 2) There was a line break AFTER the natural break
4582 // 3) It's the last line
4583 // 4) The child still fits (carry on) - 'else' clause
4585 if ((lineBreakInThisObject
&& (childSize
.x
+ currentWidth
<= availableRect
.width
))
4587 (childSize
.x
+ currentWidth
> availableRect
.width
)
4589 ((childSize
.x
+ currentWidth
<= availableRect
.width
) && !node
->GetNext())
4593 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
4595 // We can move it to the correct position at this point
4596 child
->Move(GetPosition() + wxPoint(currentWidth
, currentPosition
.y
));
4599 long wrapPosition
= 0;
4600 if ((childSize
.x
+ currentWidth
<= availableRect
.width
) && !node
->GetNext() && !lineBreakInThisObject
)
4601 wrapPosition
= child
->GetRange().GetEnd();
4604 // Find a place to wrap. This may walk back to previous children,
4605 // for example if a word spans several objects.
4606 // Note: one object must contains only one wxTextAtrr, so the line height will not
4607 // change inside one object. Thus, we can pass the remain line width to the
4608 // FindWrapPosition function.
4609 if (!FindWrapPosition(wxRichTextRange(lastCompletedEndPos
+1, child
->GetRange().GetEnd()), dc
, availableRect
.width
, wrapPosition
, & partialExtents
))
4611 // If the function failed, just cut it off at the end of this child.
4612 wrapPosition
= child
->GetRange().GetEnd();
4615 // FindWrapPosition can still return a value that will put us in an endless wrapping loop
4616 if (wrapPosition
<= lastCompletedEndPos
)
4617 wrapPosition
= wxMax(lastCompletedEndPos
+1,child
->GetRange().GetEnd());
4619 // Line end position shouldn't be the same as the end, or greater.
4620 if (wrapPosition
>= GetRange().GetEnd())
4621 wrapPosition
= GetRange().GetEnd()-1;
4623 // wxLogDebug(wxT("Split at %ld"), wrapPosition);
4625 // Let's find the actual size of the current line now
4627 wxRichTextRange
actualRange(lastCompletedEndPos
+1, wrapPosition
);
4629 /// Use previous descent, not the wrapping descent we just found, since this may be too big
4630 /// for the fragment we're about to add.
4631 childDescent
= maxDescent
;
4633 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
4634 if (!child
->IsEmpty())
4636 // Get height only, then the width using the partial extents
4637 GetRangeSize(actualRange
, actualSize
, childDescent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
|wxRICHTEXT_HEIGHT_ONLY
);
4638 actualSize
.x
= wxRichTextGetRangeWidth(*this, actualRange
, partialExtents
);
4642 GetRangeSize(actualRange
, actualSize
, childDescent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
);
4644 currentWidth
= actualSize
.x
;
4645 maxDescent
= wxMax(childDescent
, maxDescent
);
4646 maxAscent
= wxMax(actualSize
.y
-childDescent
, maxAscent
);
4647 lineHeight
= maxDescent
+ maxAscent
;
4649 if (lineHeight
== 0 && buffer
)
4651 wxFont
font(buffer
->GetFontTable().FindFont(attr
));
4652 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, font
);
4653 lineHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
4656 if (maxDescent
== 0)
4659 dc
.GetTextExtent(wxT("X"), & w
, &h
, & maxDescent
);
4663 wxRichTextLine
* line
= AllocateLine(lineCount
);
4665 // Set relative range so we won't have to change line ranges when paragraphs are moved
4666 line
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(actualRange
.GetStart() - GetRange().GetStart(), actualRange
.GetEnd() - GetRange().GetStart()));
4667 line
->SetPosition(currentPosition
);
4668 line
->SetSize(wxSize(currentWidth
, lineHeight
));
4669 line
->SetDescent(maxDescent
);
4671 maxHeight
= currentPosition
.y
+ lineHeight
;
4673 // Now move down a line. TODO: add margins, spacing
4674 currentPosition
.y
+= lineHeight
;
4675 currentPosition
.y
+= lineSpacing
;
4678 maxWidth
= wxMax(maxWidth
, currentWidth
+startOffset
);
4683 // TODO: account for zero-length objects, such as fields
4684 // wxASSERT(wrapPosition > lastCompletedEndPos);
4686 lastEndPos
= wrapPosition
;
4687 lastCompletedEndPos
= lastEndPos
;
4691 if (wrapPosition
< GetRange().GetEnd()-1)
4693 // May need to set the node back to a previous one, due to searching back in wrapping
4694 wxRichTextObject
* childAfterWrapPosition
= FindObjectAtPosition(wrapPosition
+1);
4695 if (childAfterWrapPosition
)
4696 node
= m_children
.Find(childAfterWrapPosition
);
4698 node
= node
->GetNext();
4701 node
= node
->GetNext();
4703 // Apply paragraph styles such as alignment to the wrapped line
4704 ApplyParagraphStyle(line
, attr
, availableRect
, dc
);
4708 // We still fit, so don't add a line, and keep going
4709 currentWidth
+= childSize
.x
;
4710 maxDescent
= wxMax(childDescent
, maxDescent
);
4711 maxAscent
= wxMax(childSize
.y
-childDescent
, maxAscent
);
4712 lineHeight
= maxDescent
+ maxAscent
;
4714 maxWidth
= wxMax(maxWidth
, currentWidth
+startOffset
);
4715 lastEndPos
= child
->GetRange().GetEnd();
4717 node
= node
->GetNext();
4721 //wxASSERT(!(lastCompletedEndPos != -1 && lastCompletedEndPos < GetRange().GetEnd()-1));
4723 // Remove remaining unused line objects, if any
4724 ClearUnusedLines(lineCount
);
4726 // We need to add back the margins etc.
4728 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
4729 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(maxWidth
, currentPosition
.y
+ spaceAfterPara
));
4730 GetBoxRects(dc
, buffer
, GetAttributes(), marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
4731 SetCachedSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
4734 // The maximum size is the length of the paragraph stretched out into a line.
4735 // So if there were a single word, or an image, or a fixed-size text box, the object could be shrunk around
4736 // this size. TODO: take into account line breaks.
4738 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
4739 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(paraSize
.x
+ wxMax(leftIndent
, leftIndent
+ leftSubIndent
) + rightIndent
, currentPosition
.y
+ spaceAfterPara
));
4740 GetBoxRects(dc
, buffer
, GetAttributes(), marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
4741 SetMaxSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
4744 // Find the greatest minimum size. Currently we only look at non-text objects,
4745 // which isn't ideal but it would be slow to find the maximum word width to
4746 // use as the minimum.
4749 node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
4752 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
4754 // If floating, ignore. We already laid out floats.
4755 // Also ignore if empty object, except if we haven't got any
4757 if (!child
->IsFloating() && child
->GetRange().GetLength() != 0 && !child
->IsKindOf(CLASSINFO(wxRichTextPlainText
)))
4759 if (child
->GetCachedSize().x
> minWidth
)
4760 minWidth
= child
->GetMinSize().x
;
4762 node
= node
->GetNext();
4765 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
4766 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(minWidth
, currentPosition
.y
+ spaceAfterPara
));
4767 GetBoxRects(dc
, buffer
, GetAttributes(), marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
4768 SetMinSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
4772 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
4773 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_LINE_DRAWING
4774 // Use the text extents to calculate the size of each fragment in each line
4775 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator lineNode
= m_cachedLines
.GetFirst();
4778 wxRichTextLine
* line
= lineNode
->GetData();
4779 wxRichTextRange lineRange
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
4781 // Loop through objects until we get to the one within range
4782 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node2
= m_children
.GetFirst();
4786 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node2
->GetData();
4788 if (child
->GetRange().GetLength() > 0 && !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(lineRange
))
4790 wxRichTextRange rangeToUse
= lineRange
;
4791 rangeToUse
.LimitTo(child
->GetRange());
4793 // Find the size of the child from the text extents, and store in an array
4794 // for drawing later
4796 if (rangeToUse
.GetStart() > GetRange().GetStart())
4797 left
= partialExtents
[(rangeToUse
.GetStart()-1) - GetRange().GetStart()];
4798 int right
= partialExtents
[rangeToUse
.GetEnd() - GetRange().GetStart()];
4799 int sz
= right
- left
;
4800 line
->GetObjectSizes().Add(sz
);
4802 else if (child
->GetRange().GetStart() > lineRange
.GetEnd())
4803 // Can break out of inner loop now since we've passed this line's range
4806 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
4809 lineNode
= lineNode
->GetNext();
4817 /// Apply paragraph styles, such as centering, to wrapped lines
4818 /// TODO: take into account box attributes, possibly
4819 void wxRichTextParagraph::ApplyParagraphStyle(wxRichTextLine
* line
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, const wxRect
& rect
, wxDC
& dc
)
4821 if (!attr
.HasAlignment())
4824 wxPoint pos
= line
->GetPosition();
4825 wxSize size
= line
->GetSize();
4827 // centering, right-justification
4828 if (attr
.HasAlignment() && GetAttributes().GetAlignment() == wxTEXT_ALIGNMENT_CENTRE
)
4830 int rightIndent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetRightIndent());
4831 pos
.x
= (rect
.GetWidth() - rightIndent
- size
.x
)/2 + pos
.x
;
4832 line
->SetPosition(pos
);
4834 else if (attr
.HasAlignment() && GetAttributes().GetAlignment() == wxTEXT_ALIGNMENT_RIGHT
)
4836 int rightIndent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, attr
.GetRightIndent());
4837 pos
.x
= pos
.x
+ rect
.GetWidth() - size
.x
- rightIndent
;
4838 line
->SetPosition(pos
);
4842 /// Insert text at the given position
4843 bool wxRichTextParagraph::InsertText(long pos
, const wxString
& text
)
4845 wxRichTextObject
* childToUse
= NULL
;
4846 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator nodeToUse
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
4848 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
4851 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
4852 if (child
->GetRange().Contains(pos
) && child
->GetRange().GetLength() > 0)
4859 node
= node
->GetNext();
4864 wxRichTextPlainText
* textObject
= wxDynamicCast(childToUse
, wxRichTextPlainText
);
4867 int posInString
= pos
- textObject
->GetRange().GetStart();
4869 wxString newText
= textObject
->GetText().Mid(0, posInString
) +
4870 text
+ textObject
->GetText().Mid(posInString
);
4871 textObject
->SetText(newText
);
4873 int textLength
= text
.length();
4875 textObject
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(textObject
->GetRange().GetStart(),
4876 textObject
->GetRange().GetEnd() + textLength
));
4878 // Increment the end range of subsequent fragments in this paragraph.
4879 // We'll set the paragraph range itself at a higher level.
4881 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= nodeToUse
->GetNext();
4884 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
4885 child
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(textObject
->GetRange().GetStart() + textLength
,
4886 textObject
->GetRange().GetEnd() + textLength
));
4888 node
= node
->GetNext();
4895 // TODO: if not a text object, insert at closest position, e.g. in front of it
4901 // Don't pass parent initially to suppress auto-setting of parent range.
4902 // We'll do that at a higher level.
4903 wxRichTextPlainText
* textObject
= new wxRichTextPlainText(text
, this);
4905 AppendChild(textObject
);
4912 void wxRichTextParagraph::Copy(const wxRichTextParagraph
& obj
)
4914 wxRichTextCompositeObject::Copy(obj
);
4917 /// Clear the cached lines
4918 void wxRichTextParagraph::ClearLines()
4920 WX_CLEAR_LIST(wxRichTextLineList
, m_cachedLines
);
4923 /// Get/set the object size for the given range. Returns false if the range
4924 /// is invalid for this object.
4925 bool wxRichTextParagraph::GetRangeSize(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& descent
, wxDC
& dc
, int flags
, wxPoint position
, wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
) const
4927 if (!range
.IsWithin(GetRange()))
4930 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
)
4932 // Just use unformatted data, assume no line breaks
4933 // TODO: take into account line breaks
4937 wxArrayInt childExtents
;
4944 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
4948 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
4949 if (!child
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
4951 // Floating objects have a zero size within the paragraph.
4952 if (child
->IsFloating())
4957 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
4958 lastSize
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
4962 partialExtents
->Add(0 /* zero size */ + lastSize
);
4969 wxRichTextRange rangeToUse
= range
;
4970 rangeToUse
.LimitTo(child
->GetRange());
4972 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
4973 rangeToUse
= child
->GetOwnRange();
4975 int childDescent
= 0;
4977 // At present wxRICHTEXT_HEIGHT_ONLY is only fast if we're already cached the size,
4978 // but it's only going to be used after caching has taken place.
4979 if ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_HEIGHT_ONLY
) && child
->GetCachedSize().y
!= 0)
4981 childDescent
= child
->GetDescent();
4982 childSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
4984 sz
.y
= wxMax(sz
.y
, childSize
.y
);
4985 sz
.x
+= childSize
.x
;
4986 descent
= wxMax(descent
, childDescent
);
4988 else if (child
->IsTopLevel())
4990 childDescent
= child
->GetDescent();
4991 childSize
= child
->GetCachedSize();
4993 sz
.y
= wxMax(sz
.y
, childSize
.y
);
4994 sz
.x
+= childSize
.x
;
4995 descent
= wxMax(descent
, childDescent
);
4996 if ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_CACHE_SIZE
) && (rangeToUse
== child
->GetRange()))
4998 child
->SetCachedSize(childSize
);
4999 child
->SetDescent(childDescent
);
5005 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
5006 lastSize
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
5010 partialExtents
->Add(childSize
.x
+ lastSize
);
5013 else if (child
->GetRangeSize(rangeToUse
, childSize
, childDescent
, dc
, flags
, wxPoint(position
.x
+ sz
.x
, position
.y
), p
))
5015 sz
.y
= wxMax(sz
.y
, childSize
.y
);
5016 sz
.x
+= childSize
.x
;
5017 descent
= wxMax(descent
, childDescent
);
5019 if ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_CACHE_SIZE
) && (rangeToUse
== child
->GetRange()))
5021 child
->SetCachedSize(childSize
);
5022 child
->SetDescent(childDescent
);
5028 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
5029 lastSize
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
5034 for (i
= 0; i
< childExtents
.GetCount(); i
++)
5036 partialExtents
->Add(childExtents
[i
] + lastSize
);
5046 node
= node
->GetNext();
5052 // Use formatted data, with line breaks
5055 // We're going to loop through each line, and then for each line,
5056 // call GetRangeSize for the fragment that comprises that line.
5057 // Only we have to do that multiple times within the line, because
5058 // the line may be broken into pieces. For now ignore line break commands
5059 // (so we can assume that getting the unformatted size for a fragment
5060 // within a line is the actual size)
5062 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_cachedLines
.GetFirst();
5065 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node
->GetData();
5066 wxRichTextRange lineRange
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
5067 if (!lineRange
.IsOutside(range
))
5071 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node2
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5074 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node2
->GetData();
5076 if (!child
->IsFloating() && !child
->GetRange().IsOutside(lineRange
))
5078 wxRichTextRange rangeToUse
= lineRange
;
5079 rangeToUse
.LimitTo(child
->GetRange());
5080 if (child
->IsTopLevel())
5081 rangeToUse
= child
->GetOwnRange();
5084 int childDescent
= 0;
5085 if (child
->GetRangeSize(rangeToUse
, childSize
, childDescent
, dc
, flags
, wxPoint(position
.x
+ sz
.x
, position
.y
)))
5087 lineSize
.y
= wxMax(lineSize
.y
, childSize
.y
);
5088 lineSize
.x
+= childSize
.x
;
5090 descent
= wxMax(descent
, childDescent
);
5093 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
5096 // Increase size by a line (TODO: paragraph spacing)
5098 sz
.x
= wxMax(sz
.x
, lineSize
.x
);
5100 node
= node
->GetNext();
5107 /// Finds the absolute position and row height for the given character position
5108 bool wxRichTextParagraph::FindPosition(wxDC
& dc
, long index
, wxPoint
& pt
, int* height
, bool forceLineStart
)
5112 wxRichTextLine
* line
= ((wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
*)GetParent())->GetLineAtPosition(0);
5114 *height
= line
->GetSize().y
;
5116 *height
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
5118 // -1 means 'the start of the buffer'.
5121 pt
= pt
+ line
->GetPosition();
5126 // The final position in a paragraph is taken to mean the position
5127 // at the start of the next paragraph.
5128 if (index
== GetRange().GetEnd())
5130 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* parent
= wxDynamicCast(GetParent(), wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
);
5131 wxASSERT( parent
!= NULL
);
5133 // Find the height at the next paragraph, if any
5134 wxRichTextLine
* line
= parent
->GetLineAtPosition(index
+ 1);
5137 *height
= line
->GetSize().y
;
5138 pt
= line
->GetAbsolutePosition();
5142 *height
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
5143 int indent
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, m_attributes
.GetLeftIndent());
5144 pt
= wxPoint(indent
, GetCachedSize().y
);
5150 if (index
< GetRange().GetStart() || index
> GetRange().GetEnd())
5153 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_cachedLines
.GetFirst();
5156 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node
->GetData();
5157 wxRichTextRange lineRange
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
5158 if (index
>= lineRange
.GetStart() && index
<= lineRange
.GetEnd())
5160 // If this is the last point in the line, and we're forcing the
5161 // returned value to be the start of the next line, do the required
5163 if (index
== lineRange
.GetEnd() && forceLineStart
)
5165 if (node
->GetNext())
5167 wxRichTextLine
* nextLine
= node
->GetNext()->GetData();
5168 *height
= nextLine
->GetSize().y
;
5169 pt
= nextLine
->GetAbsolutePosition();
5174 pt
.y
= line
->GetPosition().y
+ GetPosition().y
;
5176 wxRichTextRange
r(lineRange
.GetStart(), index
);
5180 // We find the size of the line up to this point,
5181 // then we can add this size to the line start position and
5182 // paragraph start position to find the actual position.
5184 if (GetRangeSize(r
, rangeSize
, descent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
, line
->GetPosition()+ GetPosition()))
5186 pt
.x
= line
->GetPosition().x
+ GetPosition().x
+ rangeSize
.x
;
5187 *height
= line
->GetSize().y
;
5194 node
= node
->GetNext();
5200 /// Hit-testing: returns a flag indicating hit test details, plus
5201 /// information about position
5202 int wxRichTextParagraph::HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, wxRichTextObject
** contextObj
, int flags
)
5205 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
5207 // If we're in the top-level container, then we can return
5208 // a suitable hit test code even if the point is outside the container area,
5209 // so that we can position the caret sensibly even if we don't
5210 // click on valid content. If we're not at the top-level, and the point
5211 // is not within this paragraph object, then we don't want to stop more
5212 // precise hit-testing from working prematurely, so return immediately.
5213 // NEW STRATEGY: use the parent boundary to test whether we're in the
5214 // right region, not the paragraph, since the paragraph may be positioned
5215 // some way in from where the user clicks.
5218 wxRichTextObject
* tempObj
, *tempContextObj
;
5219 if (GetParent() && GetParent()->wxRichTextObject::HitTest(dc
, pt
, tmpPos
, & tempObj
, & tempContextObj
, flags
) == wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
5220 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
5223 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator objNode
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5226 wxRichTextObject
* child
= objNode
->GetData();
5227 if (child
->IsTopLevel() && ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NO_NESTED_OBJECTS
) == 0))
5230 int hitTest
= child
->HitTest(dc
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, contextObj
);
5231 if (hitTest
!= wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
5236 objNode
= objNode
->GetNext();
5239 wxPoint paraPos
= GetPosition();
5241 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_cachedLines
.GetFirst();
5244 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node
->GetData();
5245 wxPoint linePos
= paraPos
+ line
->GetPosition();
5246 wxSize lineSize
= line
->GetSize();
5247 wxRichTextRange lineRange
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
5249 if (pt
.y
<= linePos
.y
+ lineSize
.y
)
5251 if (pt
.x
< linePos
.x
)
5253 textPosition
= lineRange
.GetStart();
5254 *obj
= FindObjectAtPosition(textPosition
);
5255 *contextObj
= GetContainer();
5256 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_BEFORE
|wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_OUTSIDE
;
5258 else if (pt
.x
>= (linePos
.x
+ lineSize
.x
))
5260 textPosition
= lineRange
.GetEnd();
5261 *obj
= FindObjectAtPosition(textPosition
);
5262 *contextObj
= GetContainer();
5263 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_AFTER
|wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_OUTSIDE
;
5267 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
5268 wxArrayInt partialExtents
;
5273 // This calculates the partial text extents
5274 GetRangeSize(lineRange
, paraSize
, paraDescent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
, linePos
, & partialExtents
);
5276 int lastX
= linePos
.x
;
5278 for (i
= 0; i
< partialExtents
.GetCount(); i
++)
5280 int nextX
= partialExtents
[i
] + linePos
.x
;
5282 if (pt
.x
>= lastX
&& pt
.x
<= nextX
)
5284 textPosition
= i
+ lineRange
.GetStart(); // minus 1?
5286 *obj
= FindObjectAtPosition(textPosition
);
5287 *contextObj
= GetContainer();
5289 // So now we know it's between i-1 and i.
5290 // Let's see if we can be more precise about
5291 // which side of the position it's on.
5293 int midPoint
= (nextX
+ lastX
)/2;
5294 if (pt
.x
>= midPoint
)
5295 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_AFTER
;
5297 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_BEFORE
;
5304 int lastX
= linePos
.x
;
5305 for (i
= lineRange
.GetStart(); i
<= lineRange
.GetEnd(); i
++)
5310 wxRichTextRange
rangeToUse(lineRange
.GetStart(), i
);
5312 GetRangeSize(rangeToUse
, childSize
, descent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
, linePos
);
5314 int nextX
= childSize
.x
+ linePos
.x
;
5316 if (pt
.x
>= lastX
&& pt
.x
<= nextX
)
5320 *obj
= FindObjectAtPosition(textPosition
);
5321 *contextObj
= GetContainer();
5323 // So now we know it's between i-1 and i.
5324 // Let's see if we can be more precise about
5325 // which side of the position it's on.
5327 int midPoint
= (nextX
+ lastX
)/2;
5328 if (pt
.x
>= midPoint
)
5329 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_AFTER
;
5331 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_BEFORE
;
5342 node
= node
->GetNext();
5345 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
;
5348 /// Split an object at this position if necessary, and return
5349 /// the previous object, or NULL if inserting at beginning.
5350 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextParagraph::SplitAt(long pos
, wxRichTextObject
** previousObject
)
5352 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5355 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
5357 if (pos
== child
->GetRange().GetStart())
5361 if (node
->GetPrevious())
5362 *previousObject
= node
->GetPrevious()->GetData();
5364 *previousObject
= NULL
;
5370 if (child
->GetRange().Contains(pos
))
5372 // This should create a new object, transferring part of
5373 // the content to the old object and the rest to the new object.
5374 wxRichTextObject
* newObject
= child
->DoSplit(pos
);
5376 // If we couldn't split this object, just insert in front of it.
5379 // Maybe this is an empty string, try the next one
5384 // Insert the new object after 'child'
5385 if (node
->GetNext())
5386 m_children
.Insert(node
->GetNext(), newObject
);
5388 m_children
.Append(newObject
);
5389 newObject
->SetParent(this);
5392 *previousObject
= child
;
5398 node
= node
->GetNext();
5401 *previousObject
= NULL
;
5405 /// Move content to a list from obj on
5406 void wxRichTextParagraph::MoveToList(wxRichTextObject
* obj
, wxList
& list
)
5408 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.Find(obj
);
5411 wxRichTextObject
* child
= node
->GetData();
5414 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator oldNode
= node
;
5416 node
= node
->GetNext();
5418 m_children
.DeleteNode(oldNode
);
5422 /// Add content back from list
5423 void wxRichTextParagraph::MoveFromList(wxList
& list
)
5425 for (wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= list
.GetFirst(); node
; node
= node
->GetNext())
5427 AppendChild((wxRichTextObject
*) node
->GetData());
5432 void wxRichTextParagraph::CalculateRange(long start
, long& end
)
5434 wxRichTextCompositeObject::CalculateRange(start
, end
);
5436 // Add one for end of paragraph
5439 m_range
.SetRange(start
, end
);
5442 /// Find the object at the given position
5443 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextParagraph::FindObjectAtPosition(long position
)
5445 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5448 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= node
->GetData();
5449 if (obj
->GetRange().Contains(position
) ||
5450 obj
->GetRange().GetStart() == position
||
5451 obj
->GetRange().GetEnd() == position
)
5454 node
= node
->GetNext();
5459 /// Get the plain text searching from the start or end of the range.
5460 /// The resulting string may be shorter than the range given.
5461 bool wxRichTextParagraph::GetContiguousPlainText(wxString
& text
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, bool fromStart
)
5463 text
= wxEmptyString
;
5467 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5470 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= node
->GetData();
5471 if (!obj
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
5473 wxRichTextPlainText
* textObj
= wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextPlainText
);
5476 text
+= textObj
->GetTextForRange(range
);
5484 node
= node
->GetNext();
5489 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetLast();
5492 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= node
->GetData();
5493 if (!obj
->GetRange().IsOutside(range
))
5495 wxRichTextPlainText
* textObj
= wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextPlainText
);
5498 text
= textObj
->GetTextForRange(range
) + text
;
5502 text
= wxT(" ") + text
;
5506 node
= node
->GetPrevious();
5513 /// Find a suitable wrap position.
5514 bool wxRichTextParagraph::FindWrapPosition(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxDC
& dc
, int availableSpace
, long& wrapPosition
, wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
)
5516 if (range
.GetLength() <= 0)
5519 // Find the first position where the line exceeds the available space.
5521 long breakPosition
= range
.GetEnd();
5523 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_PARTIAL_TEXT_EXTENTS
5524 if (partialExtents
&& partialExtents
->GetCount() >= (size_t) (GetRange().GetLength()-1)) // the final position in a paragraph is the newline
5528 if (range
.GetStart() > GetRange().GetStart())
5529 widthBefore
= (*partialExtents
)[range
.GetStart() - GetRange().GetStart() - 1];
5534 for (i
= (size_t) range
.GetStart(); i
<= (size_t) range
.GetEnd(); i
++)
5536 int widthFromStartOfThisRange
= (*partialExtents
)[i
- GetRange().GetStart()] - widthBefore
;
5538 if (widthFromStartOfThisRange
> availableSpace
)
5540 breakPosition
= i
-1;
5548 // Binary chop for speed
5549 long minPos
= range
.GetStart();
5550 long maxPos
= range
.GetEnd();
5553 if (minPos
== maxPos
)
5556 GetRangeSize(wxRichTextRange(range
.GetStart(), minPos
), sz
, descent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
);
5558 if (sz
.x
> availableSpace
)
5559 breakPosition
= minPos
- 1;
5562 else if ((maxPos
- minPos
) == 1)
5565 GetRangeSize(wxRichTextRange(range
.GetStart(), minPos
), sz
, descent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
);
5567 if (sz
.x
> availableSpace
)
5568 breakPosition
= minPos
- 1;
5571 GetRangeSize(wxRichTextRange(range
.GetStart(), maxPos
), sz
, descent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
);
5572 if (sz
.x
> availableSpace
)
5573 breakPosition
= maxPos
-1;
5579 long nextPos
= minPos
+ ((maxPos
- minPos
) / 2);
5582 GetRangeSize(wxRichTextRange(range
.GetStart(), nextPos
), sz
, descent
, dc
, wxRICHTEXT_UNFORMATTED
);
5584 if (sz
.x
> availableSpace
)
5596 // Now we know the last position on the line.
5597 // Let's try to find a word break.
5600 if (GetContiguousPlainText(plainText
, wxRichTextRange(range
.GetStart(), breakPosition
), false))
5602 int newLinePos
= plainText
.Find(wxRichTextLineBreakChar
);
5603 if (newLinePos
!= wxNOT_FOUND
)
5605 breakPosition
= wxMax(0, range
.GetStart() + newLinePos
);
5609 int spacePos
= plainText
.Find(wxT(' '), true);
5610 int tabPos
= plainText
.Find(wxT('\t'), true);
5611 int pos
= wxMax(spacePos
, tabPos
);
5612 if (pos
!= wxNOT_FOUND
)
5614 int positionsFromEndOfString
= plainText
.length() - pos
- 1;
5615 breakPosition
= breakPosition
- positionsFromEndOfString
;
5620 wrapPosition
= breakPosition
;
5625 /// Get the bullet text for this paragraph.
5626 wxString
wxRichTextParagraph::GetBulletText()
5628 if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() == wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_NONE
||
5629 (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_BITMAP
))
5630 return wxEmptyString
;
5632 int number
= GetAttributes().GetBulletNumber();
5635 if ((GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ARABIC
) || (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_OUTLINE
))
5637 text
.Printf(wxT("%d"), number
);
5639 else if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_LETTERS_UPPER
)
5641 // TODO: Unicode, and also check if number > 26
5642 text
.Printf(wxT("%c"), (wxChar
) (number
+64));
5644 else if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_LETTERS_LOWER
)
5646 // TODO: Unicode, and also check if number > 26
5647 text
.Printf(wxT("%c"), (wxChar
) (number
+96));
5649 else if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ROMAN_UPPER
)
5651 text
= wxRichTextDecimalToRoman(number
);
5653 else if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ROMAN_LOWER
)
5655 text
= wxRichTextDecimalToRoman(number
);
5658 else if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_SYMBOL
)
5660 text
= GetAttributes().GetBulletText();
5663 if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_OUTLINE
)
5665 // The outline style relies on the text being computed statically,
5666 // since it depends on other levels points (e.g. 1.2.1.1). So normally the bullet text
5667 // should be stored in the attributes; if not, just use the number for this
5668 // level, as previously computed.
5669 if (!GetAttributes().GetBulletText().IsEmpty())
5670 text
= GetAttributes().GetBulletText();
5673 if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_PARENTHESES
)
5675 text
= wxT("(") + text
+ wxT(")");
5677 else if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS
)
5679 text
= text
+ wxT(")");
5682 if (GetAttributes().GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_PERIOD
)
5690 /// Allocate or reuse a line object
5691 wxRichTextLine
* wxRichTextParagraph::AllocateLine(int pos
)
5693 if (pos
< (int) m_cachedLines
.GetCount())
5695 wxRichTextLine
* line
= m_cachedLines
.Item(pos
)->GetData();
5701 wxRichTextLine
* line
= new wxRichTextLine(this);
5702 m_cachedLines
.Append(line
);
5707 /// Clear remaining unused line objects, if any
5708 bool wxRichTextParagraph::ClearUnusedLines(int lineCount
)
5710 int cachedLineCount
= m_cachedLines
.GetCount();
5711 if ((int) cachedLineCount
> lineCount
)
5713 for (int i
= 0; i
< (int) (cachedLineCount
- lineCount
); i
++)
5715 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_cachedLines
.GetLast();
5716 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node
->GetData();
5717 m_cachedLines
.Erase(node
);
5724 /// Get combined attributes of the base style, paragraph style and character style. We use this to dynamically
5725 /// retrieve the actual style.
5726 wxRichTextAttr
wxRichTextParagraph::GetCombinedAttributes(const wxRichTextAttr
& contentStyle
, bool includingBoxAttr
) const
5728 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
5729 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* buf
= wxDynamicCast(GetParent(), wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
);
5732 attr
= buf
->GetBasicStyle();
5733 if (!includingBoxAttr
)
5735 attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
5736 // The background colour will be painted by the container, and we don't
5737 // want to unnecessarily overwrite the background when we're drawing text
5738 // because this may erase the guideline (which appears just under the text
5739 // if there's no padding).
5740 attr
.SetFlags(attr
.GetFlags() & ~wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
);
5742 wxRichTextApplyStyle(attr
, GetAttributes());
5745 attr
= GetAttributes();
5747 wxRichTextApplyStyle(attr
, contentStyle
);
5751 /// Get combined attributes of the base style and paragraph style.
5752 wxRichTextAttr
wxRichTextParagraph::GetCombinedAttributes(bool includingBoxAttr
) const
5754 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
5755 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* buf
= wxDynamicCast(GetParent(), wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
);
5758 attr
= buf
->GetBasicStyle();
5759 if (!includingBoxAttr
)
5760 attr
.GetTextBoxAttr().Reset();
5761 wxRichTextApplyStyle(attr
, GetAttributes());
5764 attr
= GetAttributes();
5769 // Create default tabstop array
5770 void wxRichTextParagraph::InitDefaultTabs()
5772 // create a default tab list at 10 mm each.
5773 for (int i
= 0; i
< 20; ++i
)
5775 sm_defaultTabs
.Add(i
*100);
5779 // Clear default tabstop array
5780 void wxRichTextParagraph::ClearDefaultTabs()
5782 sm_defaultTabs
.Clear();
5785 void wxRichTextParagraph::LayoutFloat(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRect
& rect
, int style
, wxRichTextFloatCollector
* floatCollector
)
5787 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= GetChildren().GetFirst();
5790 wxRichTextObject
* anchored
= node
->GetData();
5791 if (anchored
&& anchored
->IsFloating() && !floatCollector
->HasFloat(anchored
))
5795 anchored
->GetRangeSize(anchored
->GetRange(), size
, descent
, dc
, style
);
5798 if (anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetTop().IsValid())
5800 offsetY
= anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetTop().GetValue();
5801 if (anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetTop().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
5803 offsetY
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, offsetY
);
5807 int pos
= floatCollector
->GetFitPosition(anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetFloatMode(), rect
.y
+ offsetY
, size
.y
);
5809 /* Update the offset */
5810 int newOffsetY
= pos
- rect
.y
;
5811 if (newOffsetY
!= offsetY
)
5813 if (anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetTop().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
5814 newOffsetY
= ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(dc
, newOffsetY
);
5815 anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetTop().SetValue(newOffsetY
);
5818 if (anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetFloatMode() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_LEFT
)
5820 else if (anchored
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetFloatMode() == wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_RIGHT
)
5821 x
= rect
.x
+ rect
.width
- size
.x
;
5823 anchored
->SetPosition(wxPoint(x
, pos
));
5824 anchored
->SetCachedSize(size
);
5825 floatCollector
->CollectFloat(this, anchored
);
5828 node
= node
->GetNext();
5832 // Get the first position from pos that has a line break character.
5833 long wxRichTextParagraph::GetFirstLineBreakPosition(long pos
)
5835 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
5838 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= node
->GetData();
5839 if (pos
>= obj
->GetRange().GetStart() && pos
<= obj
->GetRange().GetEnd())
5841 wxRichTextPlainText
* textObj
= wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextPlainText
);
5844 long breakPos
= textObj
->GetFirstLineBreakPosition(pos
);
5849 node
= node
->GetNext();
5856 * This object represents a line in a paragraph, and stores
5857 * offsets from the start of the paragraph representing the
5858 * start and end positions of the line.
5861 wxRichTextLine::wxRichTextLine(wxRichTextParagraph
* parent
)
5867 void wxRichTextLine::Init(wxRichTextParagraph
* parent
)
5870 m_range
.SetRange(-1, -1);
5871 m_pos
= wxPoint(0, 0);
5872 m_size
= wxSize(0, 0);
5874 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_LINE_DRAWING
5875 m_objectSizes
.Clear();
5880 void wxRichTextLine::Copy(const wxRichTextLine
& obj
)
5882 m_range
= obj
.m_range
;
5883 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_LINE_DRAWING
5884 m_objectSizes
= obj
.m_objectSizes
;
5888 /// Get the absolute object position
5889 wxPoint
wxRichTextLine::GetAbsolutePosition() const
5891 return m_parent
->GetPosition() + m_pos
;
5894 /// Get the absolute range
5895 wxRichTextRange
wxRichTextLine::GetAbsoluteRange() const
5897 wxRichTextRange
range(m_range
.GetStart() + m_parent
->GetRange().GetStart(), 0);
5898 range
.SetEnd(range
.GetStart() + m_range
.GetLength()-1);
5903 * wxRichTextPlainText
5904 * This object represents a single piece of text.
5907 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextPlainText
, wxRichTextObject
)
5909 wxRichTextPlainText::wxRichTextPlainText(const wxString
& text
, wxRichTextObject
* parent
, wxRichTextAttr
* style
):
5910 wxRichTextObject(parent
)
5913 SetAttributes(*style
);
5918 #define USE_KERNING_FIX 1
5920 // If insufficient tabs are defined, this is the tab width used
5921 #define WIDTH_FOR_DEFAULT_TABS 50
5924 bool wxRichTextPlainText::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int WXUNUSED(style
))
5926 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(GetParent(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
5927 wxASSERT (para
!= NULL
);
5929 wxRichTextAttr
textAttr(para
? para
->GetCombinedAttributes(GetAttributes(), false /* no box attributes */) : GetAttributes());
5931 // Let's make the assumption for now that for content in a paragraph, including
5932 // text, we never have a discontinuous selection. So we only deal with a
5934 wxRichTextRange selectionRange
;
5935 if (selection
.IsValid())
5937 wxRichTextRangeArray selectionRanges
= selection
.GetSelectionForObject(this);
5938 if (selectionRanges
.GetCount() > 0)
5939 selectionRange
= selectionRanges
[0];
5941 selectionRange
= wxRICHTEXT_NO_SELECTION
;
5944 selectionRange
= wxRICHTEXT_NO_SELECTION
;
5946 int offset
= GetRange().GetStart();
5948 // Replace line break characters with spaces
5949 wxString str
= m_text
;
5950 wxString toRemove
= wxRichTextLineBreakChar
;
5951 str
.Replace(toRemove
, wxT(" "));
5952 if (textAttr
.HasTextEffects() && (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_CAPITALS
))
5955 long len
= range
.GetLength();
5956 wxString stringChunk
= str
.Mid(range
.GetStart() - offset
, (size_t) len
);
5958 // Test for the optimized situations where all is selected, or none
5961 wxFont
textFont(GetBuffer()->GetFontTable().FindFont(textAttr
));
5962 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, textFont
);
5963 int charHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
5966 if ( textFont
.IsOk() )
5968 if ( textAttr
.HasTextEffects() && (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_SUPERSCRIPT
) )
5970 double size
= static_cast<double>(textFont
.GetPointSize()) / wxSCRIPT_MUL_FACTOR
;
5971 textFont
.SetPointSize( static_cast<int>(size
) );
5974 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, textFont
);
5976 else if ( textAttr
.HasTextEffects() && (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_SUBSCRIPT
) )
5978 double size
= static_cast<double>(textFont
.GetPointSize()) / wxSCRIPT_MUL_FACTOR
;
5979 textFont
.SetPointSize( static_cast<int>(size
) );
5981 int sub_height
= static_cast<int>( static_cast<double>(charHeight
) / wxSCRIPT_MUL_FACTOR
);
5982 y
= rect
.y
+ (rect
.height
- sub_height
+ (descent
- m_descent
));
5983 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, textFont
);
5988 y
= rect
.y
+ (rect
.height
- charHeight
- (descent
- m_descent
));
5994 y
= rect
.y
+ (rect
.height
- charHeight
- (descent
- m_descent
));
5997 // TODO: new selection code
5999 // (a) All selected.
6000 if (selectionRange
.GetStart() <= range
.GetStart() && selectionRange
.GetEnd() >= range
.GetEnd())
6002 DrawTabbedString(dc
, textAttr
, rect
, stringChunk
, x
, y
, true);
6004 // (b) None selected.
6005 else if (selectionRange
.GetEnd() < range
.GetStart() || selectionRange
.GetStart() > range
.GetEnd())
6007 // Draw all unselected
6008 DrawTabbedString(dc
, textAttr
, rect
, stringChunk
, x
, y
, false);
6012 // (c) Part selected, part not
6013 // Let's draw unselected chunk, selected chunk, then unselected chunk.
6015 dc
.SetBackgroundMode(wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT
);
6017 // 1. Initial unselected chunk, if any, up until start of selection.
6018 if (selectionRange
.GetStart() > range
.GetStart() && selectionRange
.GetStart() <= range
.GetEnd())
6020 int r1
= range
.GetStart();
6021 int s1
= selectionRange
.GetStart()-1;
6022 int fragmentLen
= s1
- r1
+ 1;
6023 if (fragmentLen
< 0)
6025 wxLogDebug(wxT("Mid(%d, %d"), (int)(r1
- offset
), (int)fragmentLen
);
6027 wxString stringFragment
= str
.Mid(r1
- offset
, fragmentLen
);
6029 DrawTabbedString(dc
, textAttr
, rect
, stringFragment
, x
, y
, false);
6032 if (stringChunk
.Find(wxT("\t")) == wxNOT_FOUND
)
6034 // Compensate for kerning difference
6035 wxString
stringFragment2(str
.Mid(r1
- offset
, fragmentLen
+1));
6036 wxString
stringFragment3(str
.Mid(r1
- offset
+ fragmentLen
, 1));
6038 wxCoord w1
, h1
, w2
, h2
, w3
, h3
;
6039 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment
, & w1
, & h1
);
6040 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment2
, & w2
, & h2
);
6041 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment3
, & w3
, & h3
);
6043 int kerningDiff
= (w1
+ w3
) - w2
;
6044 x
= x
- kerningDiff
;
6049 // 2. Selected chunk, if any.
6050 if (selectionRange
.GetEnd() >= range
.GetStart())
6052 int s1
= wxMax(selectionRange
.GetStart(), range
.GetStart());
6053 int s2
= wxMin(selectionRange
.GetEnd(), range
.GetEnd());
6055 int fragmentLen
= s2
- s1
+ 1;
6056 if (fragmentLen
< 0)
6058 wxLogDebug(wxT("Mid(%d, %d"), (int)(s1
- offset
), (int)fragmentLen
);
6060 wxString stringFragment
= str
.Mid(s1
- offset
, fragmentLen
);
6062 DrawTabbedString(dc
, textAttr
, rect
, stringFragment
, x
, y
, true);
6065 if (stringChunk
.Find(wxT("\t")) == wxNOT_FOUND
)
6067 // Compensate for kerning difference
6068 wxString
stringFragment2(str
.Mid(s1
- offset
, fragmentLen
+1));
6069 wxString
stringFragment3(str
.Mid(s1
- offset
+ fragmentLen
, 1));
6071 wxCoord w1
, h1
, w2
, h2
, w3
, h3
;
6072 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment
, & w1
, & h1
);
6073 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment2
, & w2
, & h2
);
6074 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment3
, & w3
, & h3
);
6076 int kerningDiff
= (w1
+ w3
) - w2
;
6077 x
= x
- kerningDiff
;
6082 // 3. Remaining unselected chunk, if any
6083 if (selectionRange
.GetEnd() < range
.GetEnd())
6085 int s2
= wxMin(selectionRange
.GetEnd()+1, range
.GetEnd());
6086 int r2
= range
.GetEnd();
6088 int fragmentLen
= r2
- s2
+ 1;
6089 if (fragmentLen
< 0)
6091 wxLogDebug(wxT("Mid(%d, %d"), (int)(s2
- offset
), (int)fragmentLen
);
6093 wxString stringFragment
= str
.Mid(s2
- offset
, fragmentLen
);
6095 DrawTabbedString(dc
, textAttr
, rect
, stringFragment
, x
, y
, false);
6102 bool wxRichTextPlainText::DrawTabbedString(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, const wxRect
& rect
,wxString
& str
, wxCoord
& x
, wxCoord
& y
, bool selected
)
6104 bool hasTabs
= (str
.Find(wxT('\t')) != wxNOT_FOUND
);
6106 wxArrayInt tabArray
;
6110 if (attr
.GetTabs().IsEmpty())
6111 tabArray
= wxRichTextParagraph::GetDefaultTabs();
6113 tabArray
= attr
.GetTabs();
6114 tabCount
= tabArray
.GetCount();
6116 for (int i
= 0; i
< tabCount
; ++i
)
6118 int pos
= tabArray
[i
];
6119 pos
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, pos
);
6126 int nextTabPos
= -1;
6132 wxColour
highlightColour(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHT
));
6133 wxColour
highlightTextColour(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHTTEXT
));
6135 wxCheckSetBrush(dc
, wxBrush(highlightColour
));
6136 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, wxPen(highlightColour
));
6137 dc
.SetTextForeground(highlightTextColour
);
6138 dc
.SetBackgroundMode(wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT
);
6142 dc
.SetTextForeground(attr
.GetTextColour());
6144 if (attr
.HasFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
) && attr
.GetBackgroundColour().IsOk())
6146 dc
.SetBackgroundMode(wxBRUSHSTYLE_SOLID
);
6147 dc
.SetTextBackground(attr
.GetBackgroundColour());
6150 dc
.SetBackgroundMode(wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT
);
6153 wxCoord x_orig
= GetParent()->GetPosition().x
;
6156 // the string has a tab
6157 // break up the string at the Tab
6158 wxString stringChunk
= str
.BeforeFirst(wxT('\t'));
6159 str
= str
.AfterFirst(wxT('\t'));
6160 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringChunk
, & w
, & h
);
6162 bool not_found
= true;
6163 for (int i
= 0; i
< tabCount
&& not_found
; ++i
)
6165 nextTabPos
= tabArray
.Item(i
) + x_orig
;
6167 // Find the next tab position.
6168 // Even if we're at the end of the tab array, we must still draw the chunk.
6170 if (nextTabPos
> tabPos
|| (i
== (tabCount
- 1)))
6172 if (nextTabPos
<= tabPos
)
6174 int defaultTabWidth
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, WIDTH_FOR_DEFAULT_TABS
);
6175 nextTabPos
= tabPos
+ defaultTabWidth
;
6182 wxRect
selRect(x
, rect
.y
, w
, rect
.GetHeight());
6183 dc
.DrawRectangle(selRect
);
6185 dc
.DrawText(stringChunk
, x
, y
);
6187 if (attr
.HasTextEffects() && (attr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_STRIKETHROUGH
))
6189 wxPen oldPen
= dc
.GetPen();
6190 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, wxPen(attr
.GetTextColour(), 1));
6191 dc
.DrawLine(x
, (int) (y
+(h
/2)+0.5), x
+w
, (int) (y
+(h
/2)+0.5));
6192 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, oldPen
);
6198 hasTabs
= (str
.Find(wxT('\t')) != wxNOT_FOUND
);
6203 dc
.GetTextExtent(str
, & w
, & h
);
6206 wxRect
selRect(x
, rect
.y
, w
, rect
.GetHeight());
6207 dc
.DrawRectangle(selRect
);
6209 dc
.DrawText(str
, x
, y
);
6211 if (attr
.HasTextEffects() && (attr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_STRIKETHROUGH
))
6213 wxPen oldPen
= dc
.GetPen();
6214 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, wxPen(attr
.GetTextColour(), 1));
6215 dc
.DrawLine(x
, (int) (y
+(h
/2)+0.5), x
+w
, (int) (y
+(h
/2)+0.5));
6216 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, oldPen
);
6225 /// Lay the item out
6226 bool wxRichTextPlainText::Layout(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRect
& WXUNUSED(rect
), int WXUNUSED(style
))
6228 // Only lay out if we haven't already cached the size
6230 GetRangeSize(GetRange(), m_size
, m_descent
, dc
, 0, wxPoint(0, 0));
6232 // Eventually we want to have a reasonable estimate of minimum size.
6233 m_minSize
= wxSize(0, 0);
6238 void wxRichTextPlainText::Copy(const wxRichTextPlainText
& obj
)
6240 wxRichTextObject::Copy(obj
);
6242 m_text
= obj
.m_text
;
6245 /// Get/set the object size for the given range. Returns false if the range
6246 /// is invalid for this object.
6247 bool wxRichTextPlainText::GetRangeSize(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& descent
, wxDC
& dc
, int WXUNUSED(flags
), wxPoint position
, wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
) const
6249 if (!range
.IsWithin(GetRange()))
6252 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(GetParent(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
6253 wxASSERT (para
!= NULL
);
6255 int relativeX
= position
.x
- GetParent()->GetPosition().x
;
6257 wxRichTextAttr
textAttr(para
? para
->GetCombinedAttributes(GetAttributes()) : GetAttributes());
6259 // Always assume unformatted text, since at this level we have no knowledge
6260 // of line breaks - and we don't need it, since we'll calculate size within
6261 // formatted text by doing it in chunks according to the line ranges
6263 bool bScript(false);
6264 wxFont
font(GetBuffer()->GetFontTable().FindFont(textAttr
));
6267 if ( textAttr
.HasTextEffects() && ( (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_SUPERSCRIPT
)
6268 || (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_SUBSCRIPT
) ) )
6270 wxFont textFont
= font
;
6271 double size
= static_cast<double>(textFont
.GetPointSize()) / wxSCRIPT_MUL_FACTOR
;
6272 textFont
.SetPointSize( static_cast<int>(size
) );
6273 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, textFont
);
6278 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, font
);
6282 bool haveDescent
= false;
6283 int startPos
= range
.GetStart() - GetRange().GetStart();
6284 long len
= range
.GetLength();
6286 wxString
str(m_text
);
6287 wxString toReplace
= wxRichTextLineBreakChar
;
6288 str
.Replace(toReplace
, wxT(" "));
6290 wxString stringChunk
= str
.Mid(startPos
, (size_t) len
);
6292 if (textAttr
.HasTextEffects() && (textAttr
.GetTextEffects() & wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECT_CAPITALS
))
6293 stringChunk
.MakeUpper();
6297 if (stringChunk
.Find(wxT('\t')) != wxNOT_FOUND
)
6299 // the string has a tab
6300 wxArrayInt tabArray
;
6301 if (textAttr
.GetTabs().IsEmpty())
6302 tabArray
= wxRichTextParagraph::GetDefaultTabs();
6304 tabArray
= textAttr
.GetTabs();
6306 int tabCount
= tabArray
.GetCount();
6308 for (int i
= 0; i
< tabCount
; ++i
)
6310 int pos
= tabArray
[i
];
6311 pos
= ((wxRichTextPlainText
*) this)->ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, pos
);
6315 int nextTabPos
= -1;
6317 while (stringChunk
.Find(wxT('\t')) >= 0)
6319 int absoluteWidth
= 0;
6321 // the string has a tab
6322 // break up the string at the Tab
6323 wxString stringFragment
= stringChunk
.BeforeFirst(wxT('\t'));
6324 stringChunk
= stringChunk
.AfterFirst(wxT('\t'));
6329 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
6330 oldWidth
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
6334 // Add these partial extents
6336 dc
.GetPartialTextExtents(stringFragment
, p
);
6338 for (j
= 0; j
< p
.GetCount(); j
++)
6339 partialExtents
->Add(oldWidth
+ p
[j
]);
6341 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
6342 absoluteWidth
= (*partialExtents
)[(*partialExtents
).GetCount()-1] + relativeX
;
6344 absoluteWidth
= relativeX
;
6348 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringFragment
, & w
, & h
);
6350 absoluteWidth
= width
+ relativeX
;
6354 bool notFound
= true;
6355 for (int i
= 0; i
< tabCount
&& notFound
; ++i
)
6357 nextTabPos
= tabArray
.Item(i
);
6359 // Find the next tab position.
6360 // Even if we're at the end of the tab array, we must still process the chunk.
6362 if (nextTabPos
> absoluteWidth
|| (i
== (tabCount
- 1)))
6364 if (nextTabPos
<= absoluteWidth
)
6366 int defaultTabWidth
= ((wxRichTextPlainText
*) this)->ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, WIDTH_FOR_DEFAULT_TABS
);
6367 nextTabPos
= absoluteWidth
+ defaultTabWidth
;
6371 width
= nextTabPos
- relativeX
;
6374 partialExtents
->Add(width
);
6380 if (!stringChunk
.IsEmpty())
6385 if (partialExtents
->GetCount() > 0)
6386 oldWidth
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
6390 // Add these partial extents
6392 dc
.GetPartialTextExtents(stringChunk
, p
);
6394 for (j
= 0; j
< p
.GetCount(); j
++)
6395 partialExtents
->Add(oldWidth
+ p
[j
]);
6399 dc
.GetTextExtent(stringChunk
, & w
, & h
, & descent
);
6407 int charHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
6408 if ((*partialExtents
).GetCount() > 0)
6409 w
= (*partialExtents
)[partialExtents
->GetCount()-1];
6412 size
= wxSize(w
, charHeight
);
6416 size
= wxSize(width
, dc
.GetCharHeight());
6420 dc
.GetTextExtent(wxT("X"), & w
, & h
, & descent
);
6428 /// Do a split, returning an object containing the second part, and setting
6429 /// the first part in 'this'.
6430 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextPlainText::DoSplit(long pos
)
6432 long index
= pos
- GetRange().GetStart();
6434 if (index
< 0 || index
>= (int) m_text
.length())
6437 wxString firstPart
= m_text
.Mid(0, index
);
6438 wxString secondPart
= m_text
.Mid(index
);
6442 wxRichTextPlainText
* newObject
= new wxRichTextPlainText(secondPart
);
6443 newObject
->SetAttributes(GetAttributes());
6445 newObject
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(pos
, GetRange().GetEnd()));
6446 GetRange().SetEnd(pos
-1);
6452 void wxRichTextPlainText::CalculateRange(long start
, long& end
)
6454 end
= start
+ m_text
.length() - 1;
6455 m_range
.SetRange(start
, end
);
6459 bool wxRichTextPlainText::DeleteRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
)
6461 wxRichTextRange r
= range
;
6463 r
.LimitTo(GetRange());
6465 if (r
.GetStart() == GetRange().GetStart() && r
.GetEnd() == GetRange().GetEnd())
6471 long startIndex
= r
.GetStart() - GetRange().GetStart();
6472 long len
= r
.GetLength();
6474 m_text
= m_text
.Mid(0, startIndex
) + m_text
.Mid(startIndex
+len
);
6478 /// Get text for the given range.
6479 wxString
wxRichTextPlainText::GetTextForRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
) const
6481 wxRichTextRange r
= range
;
6483 r
.LimitTo(GetRange());
6485 long startIndex
= r
.GetStart() - GetRange().GetStart();
6486 long len
= r
.GetLength();
6488 return m_text
.Mid(startIndex
, len
);
6491 /// Returns true if this object can merge itself with the given one.
6492 bool wxRichTextPlainText::CanMerge(wxRichTextObject
* object
) const
6494 return object
->GetClassInfo() == CLASSINFO(wxRichTextPlainText
) &&
6495 (m_text
.empty() || wxTextAttrEq(GetAttributes(), object
->GetAttributes()));
6498 /// Returns true if this object merged itself with the given one.
6499 /// The calling code will then delete the given object.
6500 bool wxRichTextPlainText::Merge(wxRichTextObject
* object
)
6502 wxRichTextPlainText
* textObject
= wxDynamicCast(object
, wxRichTextPlainText
);
6503 wxASSERT( textObject
!= NULL
);
6507 m_text
+= textObject
->GetText();
6508 wxRichTextApplyStyle(m_attributes
, textObject
->GetAttributes());
6515 /// Dump to output stream for debugging
6516 void wxRichTextPlainText::Dump(wxTextOutputStream
& stream
)
6518 wxRichTextObject::Dump(stream
);
6519 stream
<< m_text
<< wxT("\n");
6522 /// Get the first position from pos that has a line break character.
6523 long wxRichTextPlainText::GetFirstLineBreakPosition(long pos
)
6526 int len
= m_text
.length();
6527 int startPos
= pos
- m_range
.GetStart();
6528 for (i
= startPos
; i
< len
; i
++)
6530 wxChar ch
= m_text
[i
];
6531 if (ch
== wxRichTextLineBreakChar
)
6533 return i
+ m_range
.GetStart();
6541 * This is a kind of box, used to represent the whole buffer
6544 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextBuffer
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
)
6546 wxList
wxRichTextBuffer::sm_handlers
;
6547 wxRichTextRenderer
* wxRichTextBuffer::sm_renderer
= NULL
;
6548 int wxRichTextBuffer::sm_bulletRightMargin
= 20;
6549 float wxRichTextBuffer::sm_bulletProportion
= (float) 0.3;
6552 void wxRichTextBuffer::Init()
6554 m_commandProcessor
= new wxCommandProcessor
;
6555 m_styleSheet
= NULL
;
6557 m_batchedCommandDepth
= 0;
6558 m_batchedCommand
= NULL
;
6565 wxRichTextBuffer::~wxRichTextBuffer()
6567 delete m_commandProcessor
;
6568 delete m_batchedCommand
;
6571 ClearEventHandlers();
6574 void wxRichTextBuffer::ResetAndClearCommands()
6578 GetCommandProcessor()->ClearCommands();
6581 Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
6584 void wxRichTextBuffer::Copy(const wxRichTextBuffer
& obj
)
6586 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Copy(obj
);
6588 m_styleSheet
= obj
.m_styleSheet
;
6589 m_modified
= obj
.m_modified
;
6590 m_batchedCommandDepth
= 0;
6591 if (m_batchedCommand
)
6592 delete m_batchedCommand
;
6593 m_batchedCommand
= NULL
;
6594 m_suppressUndo
= obj
.m_suppressUndo
;
6595 m_invalidRange
= obj
.m_invalidRange
;
6598 /// Push style sheet to top of stack
6599 bool wxRichTextBuffer::PushStyleSheet(wxRichTextStyleSheet
* styleSheet
)
6602 styleSheet
->InsertSheet(m_styleSheet
);
6604 SetStyleSheet(styleSheet
);
6609 /// Pop style sheet from top of stack
6610 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* wxRichTextBuffer::PopStyleSheet()
6614 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* oldSheet
= m_styleSheet
;
6615 m_styleSheet
= oldSheet
->GetNextSheet();
6624 /// Submit command to insert paragraphs
6625 bool wxRichTextBuffer::InsertParagraphsWithUndo(long pos
, const wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
& paragraphs
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
)
6627 return ctrl
->GetFocusObject()->InsertParagraphsWithUndo(pos
, paragraphs
, ctrl
, this, flags
);
6630 /// Submit command to insert paragraphs
6631 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertParagraphsWithUndo(long pos
, const wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
& paragraphs
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, int WXUNUSED(flags
))
6633 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Insert Text"), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
, buffer
, this, ctrl
, false);
6635 action
->GetNewParagraphs() = paragraphs
;
6637 action
->SetPosition(pos
);
6639 wxRichTextRange range
= wxRichTextRange(pos
, pos
+ paragraphs
.GetOwnRange().GetEnd() - 1);
6640 if (!paragraphs
.GetPartialParagraph())
6641 range
.SetEnd(range
.GetEnd()+1);
6643 // Set the range we'll need to delete in Undo
6644 action
->SetRange(range
);
6646 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
6651 /// Submit command to insert the given text
6652 bool wxRichTextBuffer::InsertTextWithUndo(long pos
, const wxString
& text
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
)
6654 return ctrl
->GetFocusObject()->InsertTextWithUndo(pos
, text
, ctrl
, this, flags
);
6657 /// Submit command to insert the given text
6658 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertTextWithUndo(long pos
, const wxString
& text
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, int flags
)
6660 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Insert Text"), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
, buffer
, this, ctrl
, false);
6662 wxRichTextAttr
* p
= NULL
;
6663 wxRichTextAttr paraAttr
;
6664 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_INSERT_WITH_PREVIOUS_PARAGRAPH_STYLE
)
6666 // Get appropriate paragraph style
6667 paraAttr
= GetStyleForNewParagraph(buffer
, pos
, false, false);
6668 if (!paraAttr
.IsDefault())
6672 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AddParagraphs(text
, p
);
6674 int length
= action
->GetNewParagraphs().GetOwnRange().GetLength();
6676 if (!text
.empty() && text
.Last() != wxT('\n'))
6678 // Don't count the newline when undoing
6680 action
->GetNewParagraphs().SetPartialParagraph(true);
6682 else if (!text
.empty() && text
.Last() == wxT('\n'))
6685 action
->SetPosition(pos
);
6687 // Set the range we'll need to delete in Undo
6688 action
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(pos
, pos
+ length
- 1));
6690 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
6695 /// Submit command to insert the given text
6696 bool wxRichTextBuffer::InsertNewlineWithUndo(long pos
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
)
6698 return ctrl
->GetFocusObject()->InsertNewlineWithUndo(pos
, ctrl
, this, flags
);
6701 /// Submit command to insert the given text
6702 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertNewlineWithUndo(long pos
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, int flags
)
6704 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Insert Text"), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
, buffer
, this, ctrl
, false);
6706 wxRichTextAttr
* p
= NULL
;
6707 wxRichTextAttr paraAttr
;
6708 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_INSERT_WITH_PREVIOUS_PARAGRAPH_STYLE
)
6710 paraAttr
= GetStyleForNewParagraph(buffer
, pos
, false, true /* look for next paragraph style */);
6711 if (!paraAttr
.IsDefault())
6715 wxRichTextAttr
attr(buffer
->GetDefaultStyle());
6717 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(wxEmptyString
, this, & attr
);
6718 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
6719 action
->GetNewParagraphs().UpdateRanges();
6720 action
->GetNewParagraphs().SetPartialParagraph(false);
6721 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtPosition(pos
, false);
6725 newPara
->SetAttributes(*p
);
6727 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_INSERT_INTERACTIVE
)
6729 if (para
&& para
->GetRange().GetEnd() == pos
)
6732 // Now see if we need to number the paragraph.
6733 if (newPara
->GetAttributes().HasBulletNumber())
6735 wxRichTextAttr numberingAttr
;
6736 if (FindNextParagraphNumber(para
, numberingAttr
))
6737 wxRichTextApplyStyle(newPara
->GetAttributes(), (const wxRichTextAttr
&) numberingAttr
);
6741 action
->SetPosition(pos
);
6743 // Use the default character style
6744 // Use the default character style
6745 if (!buffer
->GetDefaultStyle().IsDefault() && newPara
->GetChildren().GetFirst())
6747 // Check whether the default style merely reflects the paragraph/basic style,
6748 // in which case don't apply it.
6749 wxRichTextAttr
defaultStyle(buffer
->GetDefaultStyle());
6750 wxRichTextAttr toApply
;
6753 wxRichTextAttr combinedAttr
= para
->GetCombinedAttributes(true /* include box attributes */);
6754 wxRichTextAttr newAttr
;
6755 // This filters out attributes that are accounted for by the current
6756 // paragraph/basic style
6757 wxRichTextApplyStyle(toApply
, defaultStyle
, & combinedAttr
);
6760 toApply
= defaultStyle
;
6762 if (!toApply
.IsDefault())
6763 newPara
->GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData()->SetAttributes(toApply
);
6766 // Set the range we'll need to delete in Undo
6767 action
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(pos1
, pos1
));
6769 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
6774 /// Submit command to insert the given image
6775 bool wxRichTextBuffer::InsertImageWithUndo(long pos
, const wxRichTextImageBlock
& imageBlock
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
,
6776 const wxRichTextAttr
& textAttr
)
6778 return ctrl
->GetFocusObject()->InsertImageWithUndo(pos
, imageBlock
, ctrl
, this, flags
, textAttr
);
6781 /// Submit command to insert the given image
6782 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertImageWithUndo(long pos
, const wxRichTextImageBlock
& imageBlock
,
6783 wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, int flags
,
6784 const wxRichTextAttr
& textAttr
)
6786 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Insert Image"), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
, buffer
, this, ctrl
, false);
6788 wxRichTextAttr
* p
= NULL
;
6789 wxRichTextAttr paraAttr
;
6790 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_INSERT_WITH_PREVIOUS_PARAGRAPH_STYLE
)
6792 paraAttr
= GetStyleForNewParagraph(buffer
, pos
);
6793 if (!paraAttr
.IsDefault())
6797 wxRichTextAttr
attr(buffer
->GetDefaultStyle());
6799 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(this, & attr
);
6801 newPara
->SetAttributes(*p
);
6803 wxRichTextImage
* imageObject
= new wxRichTextImage(imageBlock
, newPara
);
6804 newPara
->AppendChild(imageObject
);
6805 imageObject
->SetAttributes(textAttr
);
6806 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
6807 action
->GetNewParagraphs().UpdateRanges();
6809 action
->GetNewParagraphs().SetPartialParagraph(true);
6811 action
->SetPosition(pos
);
6813 // Set the range we'll need to delete in Undo
6814 action
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(pos
, pos
));
6816 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
6821 // Insert an object with no change of it
6822 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextBuffer::InsertObjectWithUndo(long pos
, wxRichTextObject
*object
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, int flags
)
6824 return ctrl
->GetFocusObject()->InsertObjectWithUndo(pos
, object
, ctrl
, this, flags
);
6827 // Insert an object with no change of it
6828 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::InsertObjectWithUndo(long pos
, wxRichTextObject
*object
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, int flags
)
6830 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Insert Object"), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
, buffer
, this, ctrl
, false);
6832 wxRichTextAttr
* p
= NULL
;
6833 wxRichTextAttr paraAttr
;
6834 if (flags
& wxRICHTEXT_INSERT_WITH_PREVIOUS_PARAGRAPH_STYLE
)
6836 paraAttr
= GetStyleForNewParagraph(buffer
, pos
);
6837 if (!paraAttr
.IsDefault())
6841 wxRichTextAttr
attr(buffer
->GetDefaultStyle());
6843 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(this, & attr
);
6845 newPara
->SetAttributes(*p
);
6847 newPara
->AppendChild(object
);
6848 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AppendChild(newPara
);
6849 action
->GetNewParagraphs().UpdateRanges();
6851 action
->GetNewParagraphs().SetPartialParagraph(true);
6853 action
->SetPosition(pos
);
6855 // Set the range we'll need to delete in Undo
6856 action
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(pos
, pos
));
6858 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
6860 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= GetLeafObjectAtPosition(pos
);
6864 /// Get the style that is appropriate for a new paragraph at this position.
6865 /// If the previous paragraph has a paragraph style name, look up the next-paragraph
6867 wxRichTextAttr
wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::GetStyleForNewParagraph(wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, long pos
, bool caretPosition
, bool lookUpNewParaStyle
) const
6869 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtPosition(pos
, caretPosition
);
6872 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
6873 bool foundAttributes
= false;
6875 // Look for a matching paragraph style
6876 if (lookUpNewParaStyle
&& !para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName().IsEmpty() && buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
6878 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* paraDef
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(para
->GetAttributes().GetParagraphStyleName());
6881 // If we're not at the end of the paragraph, then we apply THIS style, and not the designated next style.
6882 if (para
->GetRange().GetEnd() == pos
&& !paraDef
->GetNextStyle().IsEmpty())
6884 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* nextParaDef
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(paraDef
->GetNextStyle());
6887 foundAttributes
= true;
6888 attr
= nextParaDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(buffer
->GetStyleSheet());
6892 // If we didn't find the 'next style', use this style instead.
6893 if (!foundAttributes
)
6895 foundAttributes
= true;
6896 attr
= paraDef
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(buffer
->GetStyleSheet());
6901 // Also apply list style if present
6902 if (lookUpNewParaStyle
&& !para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName().IsEmpty() && buffer
->GetStyleSheet())
6904 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* listDef
= buffer
->GetStyleSheet()->FindListStyle(para
->GetAttributes().GetListStyleName());
6907 int thisIndent
= para
->GetAttributes().GetLeftIndent();
6908 int thisLevel
= para
->GetAttributes().HasOutlineLevel() ? para
->GetAttributes().GetOutlineLevel() : listDef
->FindLevelForIndent(thisIndent
);
6910 // Apply the overall list style, and item style for this level
6911 wxRichTextAttr
listStyle(listDef
->GetCombinedStyleForLevel(thisLevel
, buffer
->GetStyleSheet()));
6912 wxRichTextApplyStyle(attr
, listStyle
);
6913 attr
.SetOutlineLevel(thisLevel
);
6914 if (para
->GetAttributes().HasBulletNumber())
6915 attr
.SetBulletNumber(para
->GetAttributes().GetBulletNumber());
6919 if (!foundAttributes
)
6921 attr
= para
->GetAttributes();
6922 int flags
= attr
.GetFlags();
6924 // Eliminate character styles
6925 flags
&= ( (~ wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT
) |
6926 (~ wxTEXT_ATTR_TEXT_COLOUR
) |
6927 (~ wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
) );
6928 attr
.SetFlags(flags
);
6934 return wxRichTextAttr();
6937 /// Submit command to delete this range
6938 bool wxRichTextBuffer::DeleteRangeWithUndo(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
)
6940 return ctrl
->GetFocusObject()->DeleteRangeWithUndo(range
, ctrl
, this);
6943 /// Submit command to delete this range
6944 bool wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::DeleteRangeWithUndo(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
)
6946 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Delete"), wxRICHTEXT_DELETE
, buffer
, this, ctrl
);
6948 action
->SetPosition(ctrl
->GetCaretPosition());
6950 // Set the range to delete
6951 action
->SetRange(range
);
6953 // Copy the fragment that we'll need to restore in Undo
6954 CopyFragment(range
, action
->GetOldParagraphs());
6956 // See if we're deleting a paragraph marker, in which case we need to
6957 // make a note not to copy the attributes from the 2nd paragraph to the 1st.
6958 if (range
.GetStart() == range
.GetEnd())
6960 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= GetParagraphAtPosition(range
.GetStart());
6961 if (para
&& para
->GetRange().GetEnd() == range
.GetEnd())
6963 wxRichTextParagraph
* nextPara
= GetParagraphAtPosition(range
.GetStart()+1);
6964 if (nextPara
&& nextPara
!= para
)
6966 action
->GetOldParagraphs().GetChildren().GetFirst()->GetData()->SetAttributes(nextPara
->GetAttributes());
6967 action
->GetOldParagraphs().GetAttributes().SetFlags(action
->GetOldParagraphs().GetAttributes().GetFlags() | wxTEXT_ATTR_KEEP_FIRST_PARA_STYLE
);
6972 buffer
->SubmitAction(action
);
6977 /// Collapse undo/redo commands
6978 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginBatchUndo(const wxString
& cmdName
)
6980 if (m_batchedCommandDepth
== 0)
6982 wxASSERT(m_batchedCommand
== NULL
);
6983 if (m_batchedCommand
)
6985 GetCommandProcessor()->Store(m_batchedCommand
);
6987 m_batchedCommand
= new wxRichTextCommand(cmdName
);
6990 m_batchedCommandDepth
++;
6995 /// Collapse undo/redo commands
6996 bool wxRichTextBuffer::EndBatchUndo()
6998 m_batchedCommandDepth
--;
7000 wxASSERT(m_batchedCommandDepth
>= 0);
7001 wxASSERT(m_batchedCommand
!= NULL
);
7003 if (m_batchedCommandDepth
== 0)
7005 GetCommandProcessor()->Store(m_batchedCommand
);
7006 m_batchedCommand
= NULL
;
7012 /// Submit immediately, or delay according to whether collapsing is on
7013 bool wxRichTextBuffer::SubmitAction(wxRichTextAction
* action
)
7015 if (BatchingUndo() && m_batchedCommand
&& !SuppressingUndo())
7017 wxRichTextCommand
* cmd
= new wxRichTextCommand(action
->GetName());
7018 cmd
->AddAction(action
);
7020 cmd
->GetActions().Clear();
7023 m_batchedCommand
->AddAction(action
);
7027 wxRichTextCommand
* cmd
= new wxRichTextCommand(action
->GetName());
7028 cmd
->AddAction(action
);
7030 // Only store it if we're not suppressing undo.
7031 return GetCommandProcessor()->Submit(cmd
, !SuppressingUndo());
7037 /// Begin suppressing undo/redo commands.
7038 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginSuppressUndo()
7045 /// End suppressing undo/redo commands.
7046 bool wxRichTextBuffer::EndSuppressUndo()
7053 /// Begin using a style
7054 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginStyle(const wxRichTextAttr
& style
)
7056 wxRichTextAttr
newStyle(GetDefaultStyle());
7058 // Save the old default style
7059 m_attributeStack
.Append((wxObject
*) new wxRichTextAttr(GetDefaultStyle()));
7061 wxRichTextApplyStyle(newStyle
, style
);
7062 newStyle
.SetFlags(style
.GetFlags()|newStyle
.GetFlags());
7064 SetDefaultStyle(newStyle
);
7070 bool wxRichTextBuffer::EndStyle()
7072 if (!m_attributeStack
.GetFirst())
7074 wxLogDebug(_("Too many EndStyle calls!"));
7078 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_attributeStack
.GetLast();
7079 wxRichTextAttr
* attr
= (wxRichTextAttr
*)node
->GetData();
7080 m_attributeStack
.Erase(node
);
7082 SetDefaultStyle(*attr
);
7089 bool wxRichTextBuffer::EndAllStyles()
7091 while (m_attributeStack
.GetCount() != 0)
7096 /// Clear the style stack
7097 void wxRichTextBuffer::ClearStyleStack()
7099 for (wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_attributeStack
.GetFirst(); node
; node
= node
->GetNext())
7100 delete (wxRichTextAttr
*) node
->GetData();
7101 m_attributeStack
.Clear();
7104 /// Begin using bold
7105 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginBold()
7107 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7108 attr
.SetFontWeight(wxFONTWEIGHT_BOLD
);
7110 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7113 /// Begin using italic
7114 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginItalic()
7116 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7117 attr
.SetFontStyle(wxFONTSTYLE_ITALIC
);
7119 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7122 /// Begin using underline
7123 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginUnderline()
7125 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7126 attr
.SetFontUnderlined(true);
7128 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7131 /// Begin using point size
7132 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginFontSize(int pointSize
)
7134 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7135 attr
.SetFontSize(pointSize
);
7137 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7140 /// Begin using this font
7141 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginFont(const wxFont
& font
)
7143 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7146 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7149 /// Begin using this colour
7150 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginTextColour(const wxColour
& colour
)
7152 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7153 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_TEXT_COLOUR
);
7154 attr
.SetTextColour(colour
);
7156 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7159 /// Begin using alignment
7160 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginAlignment(wxTextAttrAlignment alignment
)
7162 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7163 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_ALIGNMENT
);
7164 attr
.SetAlignment(alignment
);
7166 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7169 /// Begin left indent
7170 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginLeftIndent(int leftIndent
, int leftSubIndent
)
7172 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7173 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
7174 attr
.SetLeftIndent(leftIndent
, leftSubIndent
);
7176 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7179 /// Begin right indent
7180 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginRightIndent(int rightIndent
)
7182 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7183 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_RIGHT_INDENT
);
7184 attr
.SetRightIndent(rightIndent
);
7186 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7189 /// Begin paragraph spacing
7190 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginParagraphSpacing(int before
, int after
)
7194 flags
|= wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_BEFORE
;
7196 flags
|= wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_AFTER
;
7198 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7199 attr
.SetFlags(flags
);
7200 attr
.SetParagraphSpacingBefore(before
);
7201 attr
.SetParagraphSpacingAfter(after
);
7203 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7206 /// Begin line spacing
7207 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginLineSpacing(int lineSpacing
)
7209 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7210 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_LINE_SPACING
);
7211 attr
.SetLineSpacing(lineSpacing
);
7213 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7216 /// Begin numbered bullet
7217 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginNumberedBullet(int bulletNumber
, int leftIndent
, int leftSubIndent
, int bulletStyle
)
7219 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7220 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
|wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
7221 attr
.SetBulletStyle(bulletStyle
);
7222 attr
.SetBulletNumber(bulletNumber
);
7223 attr
.SetLeftIndent(leftIndent
, leftSubIndent
);
7225 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7228 /// Begin symbol bullet
7229 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginSymbolBullet(const wxString
& symbol
, int leftIndent
, int leftSubIndent
, int bulletStyle
)
7231 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7232 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
|wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
7233 attr
.SetBulletStyle(bulletStyle
);
7234 attr
.SetLeftIndent(leftIndent
, leftSubIndent
);
7235 attr
.SetBulletText(symbol
);
7237 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7240 /// Begin standard bullet
7241 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginStandardBullet(const wxString
& bulletName
, int leftIndent
, int leftSubIndent
, int bulletStyle
)
7243 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7244 attr
.SetFlags(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
|wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
7245 attr
.SetBulletStyle(bulletStyle
);
7246 attr
.SetLeftIndent(leftIndent
, leftSubIndent
);
7247 attr
.SetBulletName(bulletName
);
7249 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7252 /// Begin named character style
7253 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginCharacterStyle(const wxString
& characterStyle
)
7255 if (GetStyleSheet())
7257 wxRichTextCharacterStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindCharacterStyle(characterStyle
);
7260 wxRichTextAttr attr
= def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(GetStyleSheet());
7261 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7267 /// Begin named paragraph style
7268 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginParagraphStyle(const wxString
& paragraphStyle
)
7270 if (GetStyleSheet())
7272 wxRichTextParagraphStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindParagraphStyle(paragraphStyle
);
7275 wxRichTextAttr attr
= def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(GetStyleSheet());
7276 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7282 /// Begin named list style
7283 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginListStyle(const wxString
& listStyle
, int level
, int number
)
7285 if (GetStyleSheet())
7287 wxRichTextListStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindListStyle(listStyle
);
7290 wxRichTextAttr
attr(def
->GetCombinedStyleForLevel(level
));
7292 attr
.SetBulletNumber(number
);
7294 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7301 bool wxRichTextBuffer::BeginURL(const wxString
& url
, const wxString
& characterStyle
)
7303 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
7305 if (!characterStyle
.IsEmpty() && GetStyleSheet())
7307 wxRichTextCharacterStyleDefinition
* def
= GetStyleSheet()->FindCharacterStyle(characterStyle
);
7310 attr
= def
->GetStyleMergedWithBase(GetStyleSheet());
7315 return BeginStyle(attr
);
7318 /// Adds a handler to the end
7319 void wxRichTextBuffer::AddHandler(wxRichTextFileHandler
*handler
)
7321 sm_handlers
.Append(handler
);
7324 /// Inserts a handler at the front
7325 void wxRichTextBuffer::InsertHandler(wxRichTextFileHandler
*handler
)
7327 sm_handlers
.Insert( handler
);
7330 /// Removes a handler
7331 bool wxRichTextBuffer::RemoveHandler(const wxString
& name
)
7333 wxRichTextFileHandler
*handler
= FindHandler(name
);
7336 sm_handlers
.DeleteObject(handler
);
7344 /// Finds a handler by filename or, if supplied, type
7345 wxRichTextFileHandler
*wxRichTextBuffer::FindHandlerFilenameOrType(const wxString
& filename
,
7346 wxRichTextFileType imageType
)
7348 if (imageType
!= wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_ANY
)
7349 return FindHandler(imageType
);
7350 else if (!filename
.IsEmpty())
7352 wxString path
, file
, ext
;
7353 wxFileName::SplitPath(filename
, & path
, & file
, & ext
);
7354 return FindHandler(ext
, imageType
);
7361 /// Finds a handler by name
7362 wxRichTextFileHandler
* wxRichTextBuffer::FindHandler(const wxString
& name
)
7364 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= sm_handlers
.GetFirst();
7367 wxRichTextFileHandler
*handler
= (wxRichTextFileHandler
*)node
->GetData();
7368 if (handler
->GetName().Lower() == name
.Lower()) return handler
;
7370 node
= node
->GetNext();
7375 /// Finds a handler by extension and type
7376 wxRichTextFileHandler
* wxRichTextBuffer::FindHandler(const wxString
& extension
, wxRichTextFileType type
)
7378 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= sm_handlers
.GetFirst();
7381 wxRichTextFileHandler
*handler
= (wxRichTextFileHandler
*)node
->GetData();
7382 if ( handler
->GetExtension().Lower() == extension
.Lower() &&
7383 (type
== wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_ANY
|| handler
->GetType() == type
) )
7385 node
= node
->GetNext();
7390 /// Finds a handler by type
7391 wxRichTextFileHandler
* wxRichTextBuffer::FindHandler(wxRichTextFileType type
)
7393 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= sm_handlers
.GetFirst();
7396 wxRichTextFileHandler
*handler
= (wxRichTextFileHandler
*)node
->GetData();
7397 if (handler
->GetType() == type
) return handler
;
7398 node
= node
->GetNext();
7403 void wxRichTextBuffer::InitStandardHandlers()
7405 if (!FindHandler(wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_TEXT
))
7406 AddHandler(new wxRichTextPlainTextHandler
);
7409 void wxRichTextBuffer::CleanUpHandlers()
7411 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= sm_handlers
.GetFirst();
7414 wxRichTextFileHandler
* handler
= (wxRichTextFileHandler
*)node
->GetData();
7415 wxList::compatibility_iterator next
= node
->GetNext();
7420 sm_handlers
.Clear();
7423 wxString
wxRichTextBuffer::GetExtWildcard(bool combine
, bool save
, wxArrayInt
* types
)
7430 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= GetHandlers().GetFirst();
7434 wxRichTextFileHandler
* handler
= (wxRichTextFileHandler
*) node
->GetData();
7435 if (handler
->IsVisible() && ((save
&& handler
->CanSave()) || (!save
&& handler
->CanLoad())))
7440 wildcard
+= wxT(";");
7441 wildcard
+= wxT("*.") + handler
->GetExtension();
7446 wildcard
+= wxT("|");
7447 wildcard
+= handler
->GetName();
7448 wildcard
+= wxT(" ");
7449 wildcard
+= _("files");
7450 wildcard
+= wxT(" (*.");
7451 wildcard
+= handler
->GetExtension();
7452 wildcard
+= wxT(")|*.");
7453 wildcard
+= handler
->GetExtension();
7455 types
->Add(handler
->GetType());
7460 node
= node
->GetNext();
7464 wildcard
= wxT("(") + wildcard
+ wxT(")|") + wildcard
;
7469 bool wxRichTextBuffer::LoadFile(const wxString
& filename
, wxRichTextFileType type
)
7471 wxRichTextFileHandler
* handler
= FindHandlerFilenameOrType(filename
, type
);
7474 SetDefaultStyle(wxRichTextAttr());
7475 handler
->SetFlags(GetHandlerFlags());
7476 bool success
= handler
->LoadFile(this, filename
);
7477 Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
7485 bool wxRichTextBuffer::SaveFile(const wxString
& filename
, wxRichTextFileType type
)
7487 wxRichTextFileHandler
* handler
= FindHandlerFilenameOrType(filename
, type
);
7490 handler
->SetFlags(GetHandlerFlags());
7491 return handler
->SaveFile(this, filename
);
7497 /// Load from a stream
7498 bool wxRichTextBuffer::LoadFile(wxInputStream
& stream
, wxRichTextFileType type
)
7500 wxRichTextFileHandler
* handler
= FindHandler(type
);
7503 SetDefaultStyle(wxRichTextAttr());
7504 handler
->SetFlags(GetHandlerFlags());
7505 bool success
= handler
->LoadFile(this, stream
);
7506 Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
7513 /// Save to a stream
7514 bool wxRichTextBuffer::SaveFile(wxOutputStream
& stream
, wxRichTextFileType type
)
7516 wxRichTextFileHandler
* handler
= FindHandler(type
);
7519 handler
->SetFlags(GetHandlerFlags());
7520 return handler
->SaveFile(this, stream
);
7526 /// Copy the range to the clipboard
7527 bool wxRichTextBuffer::CopyToClipboard(const wxRichTextRange
& range
)
7529 bool success
= false;
7530 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= this;
7531 if (GetRichTextCtrl())
7532 container
= GetRichTextCtrl()->GetFocusObject();
7534 #if wxUSE_CLIPBOARD && wxUSE_DATAOBJ
7536 if (!wxTheClipboard
->IsOpened() && wxTheClipboard
->Open())
7538 wxTheClipboard
->Clear();
7540 // Add composite object
7542 wxDataObjectComposite
* compositeObject
= new wxDataObjectComposite();
7545 wxString text
= container
->GetTextForRange(range
);
7548 text
= wxTextFile::Translate(text
, wxTextFileType_Dos
);
7551 compositeObject
->Add(new wxTextDataObject(text
), false /* not preferred */);
7554 // Add rich text buffer data object. This needs the XML handler to be present.
7556 if (FindHandler(wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_XML
))
7558 wxRichTextBuffer
* richTextBuf
= new wxRichTextBuffer
;
7559 container
->CopyFragment(range
, *richTextBuf
);
7561 compositeObject
->Add(new wxRichTextBufferDataObject(richTextBuf
), true /* preferred */);
7564 if (wxTheClipboard
->SetData(compositeObject
))
7567 wxTheClipboard
->Close();
7576 /// Paste the clipboard content to the buffer
7577 bool wxRichTextBuffer::PasteFromClipboard(long position
)
7579 bool success
= false;
7580 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= this;
7581 if (GetRichTextCtrl())
7582 container
= GetRichTextCtrl()->GetFocusObject();
7584 #if wxUSE_CLIPBOARD && wxUSE_DATAOBJ
7585 if (CanPasteFromClipboard())
7587 if (wxTheClipboard
->Open())
7589 if (wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDataFormat(wxRichTextBufferDataObject::GetRichTextBufferFormatId())))
7591 wxRichTextBufferDataObject data
;
7592 wxTheClipboard
->GetData(data
);
7593 wxRichTextBuffer
* richTextBuffer
= data
.GetRichTextBuffer();
7596 container
->InsertParagraphsWithUndo(position
+1, *richTextBuffer
, GetRichTextCtrl(), this, 0);
7597 if (GetRichTextCtrl())
7598 GetRichTextCtrl()->ShowPosition(position
+ richTextBuffer
->GetOwnRange().GetEnd());
7599 delete richTextBuffer
;
7602 else if (wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDF_TEXT
)
7604 || wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDF_UNICODETEXT
)
7608 wxTextDataObject data
;
7609 wxTheClipboard
->GetData(data
);
7610 wxString
text(data
.GetText());
7613 text2
.Alloc(text
.Length()+1);
7615 for (i
= 0; i
< text
.Length(); i
++)
7617 wxChar ch
= text
[i
];
7618 if (ch
!= wxT('\r'))
7622 wxString text2
= text
;
7624 container
->InsertTextWithUndo(position
+1, text2
, GetRichTextCtrl(), this, wxRICHTEXT_INSERT_WITH_PREVIOUS_PARAGRAPH_STYLE
);
7626 if (GetRichTextCtrl())
7627 GetRichTextCtrl()->ShowPosition(position
+ text2
.Length());
7631 else if (wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDF_BITMAP
))
7633 wxBitmapDataObject data
;
7634 wxTheClipboard
->GetData(data
);
7635 wxBitmap
bitmap(data
.GetBitmap());
7636 wxImage
image(bitmap
.ConvertToImage());
7638 wxRichTextAction
* action
= new wxRichTextAction(NULL
, _("Insert Image"), wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
, this, container
, GetRichTextCtrl(), false);
7640 action
->GetNewParagraphs().AddImage(image
);
7642 if (action
->GetNewParagraphs().GetChildCount() == 1)
7643 action
->GetNewParagraphs().SetPartialParagraph(true);
7645 action
->SetPosition(position
+1);
7647 // Set the range we'll need to delete in Undo
7648 action
->SetRange(wxRichTextRange(position
+1, position
+1));
7650 SubmitAction(action
);
7654 wxTheClipboard
->Close();
7658 wxUnusedVar(position
);
7663 /// Can we paste from the clipboard?
7664 bool wxRichTextBuffer::CanPasteFromClipboard() const
7666 bool canPaste
= false;
7667 #if wxUSE_CLIPBOARD && wxUSE_DATAOBJ
7668 if (!wxTheClipboard
->IsOpened() && wxTheClipboard
->Open())
7670 if (wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDF_TEXT
)
7672 || wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDF_UNICODETEXT
)
7674 || wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDataFormat(wxRichTextBufferDataObject::GetRichTextBufferFormatId())) ||
7675 wxTheClipboard
->IsSupported(wxDF_BITMAP
))
7679 wxTheClipboard
->Close();
7685 /// Dumps contents of buffer for debugging purposes
7686 void wxRichTextBuffer::Dump()
7690 wxStringOutputStream
stream(& text
);
7691 wxTextOutputStream
textStream(stream
);
7698 /// Add an event handler
7699 bool wxRichTextBuffer::AddEventHandler(wxEvtHandler
* handler
)
7701 m_eventHandlers
.Append(handler
);
7705 /// Remove an event handler
7706 bool wxRichTextBuffer::RemoveEventHandler(wxEvtHandler
* handler
, bool deleteHandler
)
7708 wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_eventHandlers
.Find(handler
);
7711 m_eventHandlers
.Erase(node
);
7721 /// Clear event handlers
7722 void wxRichTextBuffer::ClearEventHandlers()
7724 m_eventHandlers
.Clear();
7727 /// Send event to event handlers. If sendToAll is true, will send to all event handlers,
7728 /// otherwise will stop at the first successful one.
7729 bool wxRichTextBuffer::SendEvent(wxEvent
& event
, bool sendToAll
)
7731 bool success
= false;
7732 for (wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_eventHandlers
.GetFirst(); node
; node
= node
->GetNext())
7734 wxEvtHandler
* handler
= (wxEvtHandler
*) node
->GetData();
7735 if (handler
->ProcessEvent(event
))
7745 /// Set style sheet and notify of the change
7746 bool wxRichTextBuffer::SetStyleSheetAndNotify(wxRichTextStyleSheet
* sheet
)
7748 wxRichTextStyleSheet
* oldSheet
= GetStyleSheet();
7750 wxWindowID winid
= wxID_ANY
;
7751 if (GetRichTextCtrl())
7752 winid
= GetRichTextCtrl()->GetId();
7754 wxRichTextEvent
event(wxEVT_COMMAND_RICHTEXT_STYLESHEET_REPLACING
, winid
);
7755 event
.SetEventObject(GetRichTextCtrl());
7756 event
.SetContainer(GetRichTextCtrl()->GetFocusObject());
7757 event
.SetOldStyleSheet(oldSheet
);
7758 event
.SetNewStyleSheet(sheet
);
7761 if (SendEvent(event
) && !event
.IsAllowed())
7763 if (sheet
!= oldSheet
)
7769 if (oldSheet
&& oldSheet
!= sheet
)
7772 SetStyleSheet(sheet
);
7774 event
.SetEventType(wxEVT_COMMAND_RICHTEXT_STYLESHEET_REPLACED
);
7775 event
.SetOldStyleSheet(NULL
);
7778 return SendEvent(event
);
7781 /// Set renderer, deleting old one
7782 void wxRichTextBuffer::SetRenderer(wxRichTextRenderer
* renderer
)
7786 sm_renderer
= renderer
;
7789 /// Hit-testing: returns a flag indicating hit test details, plus
7790 /// information about position
7791 int wxRichTextBuffer::HitTest(wxDC
& dc
, const wxPoint
& pt
, long& textPosition
, wxRichTextObject
** obj
, wxRichTextObject
** contextObj
, int flags
)
7793 int ret
= wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::HitTest(dc
, pt
, textPosition
, obj
, contextObj
, flags
);
7794 if (ret
!= wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_NONE
)
7800 textPosition
= m_ownRange
.GetEnd()-1;
7803 return wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_AFTER
|wxRICHTEXT_HITTEST_OUTSIDE
;
7807 bool wxRichTextStdRenderer::DrawStandardBullet(wxRichTextParagraph
* paragraph
, wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextAttr
& bulletAttr
, const wxRect
& rect
)
7809 if (bulletAttr
.GetTextColour().IsOk())
7811 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, wxPen(bulletAttr
.GetTextColour()));
7812 wxCheckSetBrush(dc
, wxBrush(bulletAttr
.GetTextColour()));
7816 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, *wxBLACK_PEN
);
7817 wxCheckSetBrush(dc
, *wxBLACK_BRUSH
);
7821 if (bulletAttr
.HasFont())
7823 font
= paragraph
->GetBuffer()->GetFontTable().FindFont(bulletAttr
);
7826 font
= (*wxNORMAL_FONT
);
7828 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, font
);
7830 int charHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
7832 int bulletWidth
= (int) (((float) charHeight
) * wxRichTextBuffer::GetBulletProportion());
7833 int bulletHeight
= bulletWidth
;
7837 // Calculate the top position of the character (as opposed to the whole line height)
7838 int y
= rect
.y
+ (rect
.height
- charHeight
);
7840 // Calculate where the bullet should be positioned
7841 y
= y
+ (charHeight
+1)/2 - (bulletHeight
+1)/2;
7843 // The margin between a bullet and text.
7844 int margin
= paragraph
->ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, wxRichTextBuffer::GetBulletRightMargin());
7846 if (bulletAttr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ALIGN_RIGHT
)
7847 x
= rect
.x
+ rect
.width
- bulletWidth
- margin
;
7848 else if (bulletAttr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ALIGN_CENTRE
)
7849 x
= x
+ (rect
.width
)/2 - bulletWidth
/2;
7851 if (bulletAttr
.GetBulletName() == wxT("standard/square"))
7853 dc
.DrawRectangle(x
, y
, bulletWidth
, bulletHeight
);
7855 else if (bulletAttr
.GetBulletName() == wxT("standard/diamond"))
7858 pts
[0].x
= x
; pts
[0].y
= y
+ bulletHeight
/2;
7859 pts
[1].x
= x
+ bulletWidth
/2; pts
[1].y
= y
;
7860 pts
[2].x
= x
+ bulletWidth
; pts
[2].y
= y
+ bulletHeight
/2;
7861 pts
[3].x
= x
+ bulletWidth
/2; pts
[3].y
= y
+ bulletHeight
;
7863 dc
.DrawPolygon(4, pts
);
7865 else if (bulletAttr
.GetBulletName() == wxT("standard/triangle"))
7868 pts
[0].x
= x
; pts
[0].y
= y
;
7869 pts
[1].x
= x
+ bulletWidth
; pts
[1].y
= y
+ bulletHeight
/2;
7870 pts
[2].x
= x
; pts
[2].y
= y
+ bulletHeight
;
7872 dc
.DrawPolygon(3, pts
);
7874 else if (bulletAttr
.GetBulletName() == wxT("standard/circle-outline"))
7876 wxCheckSetBrush(dc
, *wxTRANSPARENT_BRUSH
);
7877 dc
.DrawEllipse(x
, y
, bulletWidth
, bulletHeight
);
7879 else // "standard/circle", and catch-all
7881 dc
.DrawEllipse(x
, y
, bulletWidth
, bulletHeight
);
7887 bool wxRichTextStdRenderer::DrawTextBullet(wxRichTextParagraph
* paragraph
, wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, const wxRect
& rect
, const wxString
& text
)
7892 if ((attr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_SYMBOL
) && !attr
.GetBulletFont().IsEmpty() && attr
.HasFont())
7894 wxRichTextAttr fontAttr
;
7895 fontAttr
.SetFontSize(attr
.GetFontSize());
7896 fontAttr
.SetFontStyle(attr
.GetFontStyle());
7897 fontAttr
.SetFontWeight(attr
.GetFontWeight());
7898 fontAttr
.SetFontUnderlined(attr
.GetFontUnderlined());
7899 fontAttr
.SetFontFaceName(attr
.GetBulletFont());
7900 font
= paragraph
->GetBuffer()->GetFontTable().FindFont(fontAttr
);
7902 else if (attr
.HasFont())
7903 font
= paragraph
->GetBuffer()->GetFontTable().FindFont(attr
);
7905 font
= (*wxNORMAL_FONT
);
7907 wxCheckSetFont(dc
, font
);
7909 if (attr
.GetTextColour().IsOk())
7910 dc
.SetTextForeground(attr
.GetTextColour());
7912 dc
.SetBackgroundMode(wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT
);
7914 int charHeight
= dc
.GetCharHeight();
7916 dc
.GetTextExtent(text
, & tw
, & th
);
7920 // Calculate the top position of the character (as opposed to the whole line height)
7921 int y
= rect
.y
+ (rect
.height
- charHeight
);
7923 // The margin between a bullet and text.
7924 int margin
= paragraph
->ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, wxRichTextBuffer::GetBulletRightMargin());
7926 if (attr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ALIGN_RIGHT
)
7927 x
= (rect
.x
+ rect
.width
) - tw
- margin
;
7928 else if (attr
.GetBulletStyle() & wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE_ALIGN_CENTRE
)
7929 x
= x
+ (rect
.width
)/2 - tw
/2;
7931 dc
.DrawText(text
, x
, y
);
7939 bool wxRichTextStdRenderer::DrawBitmapBullet(wxRichTextParagraph
* WXUNUSED(paragraph
), wxDC
& WXUNUSED(dc
), const wxRichTextAttr
& WXUNUSED(attr
), const wxRect
& WXUNUSED(rect
))
7941 // Currently unimplemented. The intention is to store bitmaps by name in a media store associated
7942 // with the buffer. The store will allow retrieval from memory, disk or other means.
7946 /// Enumerate the standard bullet names currently supported
7947 bool wxRichTextStdRenderer::EnumerateStandardBulletNames(wxArrayString
& bulletNames
)
7949 bulletNames
.Add(wxTRANSLATE("standard/circle"));
7950 bulletNames
.Add(wxTRANSLATE("standard/circle-outline"));
7951 bulletNames
.Add(wxTRANSLATE("standard/square"));
7952 bulletNames
.Add(wxTRANSLATE("standard/diamond"));
7953 bulletNames
.Add(wxTRANSLATE("standard/triangle"));
7962 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextBox
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
)
7964 wxRichTextBox::wxRichTextBox(wxRichTextObject
* parent
):
7965 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox(parent
)
7970 bool wxRichTextBox::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
7975 // TODO: if the active object in the control, draw an indication.
7976 // We need to add the concept of active object, and not just focus object,
7977 // so we can apply commands (properties, delete, ...) to objects such as text boxes and images.
7978 // Ultimately we would like to be able to interactively resize an active object
7979 // using drag handles.
7980 return wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Draw(dc
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
7984 void wxRichTextBox::Copy(const wxRichTextBox
& obj
)
7986 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox::Copy(obj
);
7989 // Edit properties via a GUI
7990 bool wxRichTextBox::EditProperties(wxWindow
* parent
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
)
7992 wxRichTextObjectPropertiesDialog
boxDlg(this, wxGetTopLevelParent(parent
), wxID_ANY
, _("Box Properties"));
7993 boxDlg
.SetAttributes(GetAttributes());
7995 if (boxDlg
.ShowModal() == wxID_OK
)
7997 // By passing wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET, indeterminate attributes set by the user will be set as
7998 // indeterminate in the object.
7999 boxDlg
.ApplyStyle(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl(), wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
|wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET
);
8006 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextCell
, wxRichTextBox
)
8008 wxRichTextCell::wxRichTextCell(wxRichTextObject
* parent
):
8009 wxRichTextBox(parent
)
8014 bool wxRichTextCell::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
8016 return wxRichTextBox::Draw(dc
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
8020 void wxRichTextCell::Copy(const wxRichTextCell
& obj
)
8022 wxRichTextBox::Copy(obj
);
8025 // Edit properties via a GUI
8026 bool wxRichTextCell::EditProperties(wxWindow
* parent
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
)
8028 // We need to gather common attributes for all selected cells.
8030 wxRichTextTable
* table
= wxDynamicCast(GetParent(), wxRichTextTable
);
8031 bool multipleCells
= false;
8032 wxRichTextAttr attr
;
8034 if (table
&& buffer
&& buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl() && buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetSelection().IsValid() &&
8035 buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetSelection().GetContainer() == GetParent())
8037 wxRichTextAttr clashingAttr
, absentAttr
;
8038 const wxRichTextSelection
& sel
= buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetSelection();
8040 int selectedCellCount
= 0;
8041 for (i
= 0; i
< sel
.GetCount(); i
++)
8043 const wxRichTextRange
& range
= sel
[i
];
8044 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= table
->GetCell(range
.GetStart());
8047 wxRichTextAttr cellStyle
= cell
->GetAttributes();
8049 CollectStyle(attr
, cellStyle
, clashingAttr
, absentAttr
);
8051 selectedCellCount
++;
8054 multipleCells
= selectedCellCount
> 1;
8058 attr
= GetAttributes();
8063 caption
= _("Multiple Cell Properties");
8065 caption
= _("Cell Properties");
8067 wxRichTextObjectPropertiesDialog
cellDlg(this, wxGetTopLevelParent(parent
), wxID_ANY
, caption
);
8068 cellDlg
.SetAttributes(attr
);
8070 wxRichTextSizePage
* sizePage
= wxDynamicCast(cellDlg
.FindPage(CLASSINFO(wxRichTextSizePage
)), wxRichTextSizePage
);
8073 // We don't want position and floating controls for a cell.
8074 sizePage
->ShowPositionControls(false);
8075 sizePage
->ShowFloatingControls(false);
8078 if (cellDlg
.ShowModal() == wxID_OK
)
8082 const wxRichTextSelection
& sel
= buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl()->GetSelection();
8083 // Apply the style; we interpret indeterminate attributes as 'don't touch this attribute'
8084 // since it may represent clashing attributes across multiple objects.
8085 table
->SetCellStyle(sel
, attr
);
8088 // For a single object, indeterminate attributes set by the user should be reflected in the
8089 // actual object style, so pass the wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET flag to assign
8090 // the style directly instead of applying (which ignores indeterminate attributes,
8091 // leaving them as they were).
8092 cellDlg
.ApplyStyle(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl(), wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
|wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET
);
8099 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxRichTextObjectPtrArrayArray
)
8101 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextTable
, wxRichTextBox
)
8103 wxRichTextTable::wxRichTextTable(wxRichTextObject
* parent
): wxRichTextBox(parent
)
8109 // Draws the object.
8110 bool wxRichTextTable::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int descent
, int style
)
8112 return wxRichTextBox::Draw(dc
, range
, selection
, rect
, descent
, style
);
8115 WX_DECLARE_OBJARRAY(wxRect
, wxRichTextRectArray
);
8116 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxRichTextRectArray
);
8118 // Lays the object out. rect is the space available for layout. Often it will
8119 // be the specified overall space for this object, if trying to constrain
8120 // layout to a particular size, or it could be the total space available in the
8121 // parent. rect is the overall size, so we must subtract margins and padding.
8122 // to get the actual available space.
8123 bool wxRichTextTable::Layout(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRect
& rect
, int style
)
8125 SetPosition(rect
.GetPosition());
8127 // TODO: the meaty bit. Calculate sizes of all cells and rows. Try to use
8128 // minimum size if within alloted size, then divide up remaining size
8129 // between rows/cols.
8132 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
8133 if (buffer
) scale
= buffer
->GetScale();
8135 wxRect availableSpace
= GetAvailableContentArea(dc
, rect
);
8136 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, scale
, availableSpace
.GetSize());
8138 // If we have no fixed table size, and assuming we're not pushed for
8139 // space, then we don't have to try to stretch the table to fit the contents.
8140 bool stretchToFitTableWidth
= false;
8142 int tableWidth
= rect
.width
;
8143 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().IsValid())
8145 tableWidth
= converter
.GetPixels(GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth());
8147 // Fixed table width, so we do want to stretch columns out if necessary.
8148 stretchToFitTableWidth
= true;
8150 // Shouldn't be able to exceed the size passed to this function
8151 tableWidth
= wxMin(rect
.width
, tableWidth
);
8154 // Get internal padding
8155 int paddingLeft
= 0, paddingRight
= 0, paddingTop
= 0, paddingBottom
= 0;
8156 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetLeft().IsValid())
8157 paddingLeft
= converter
.GetPixels(GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetLeft());
8158 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetRight().IsValid())
8159 paddingRight
= converter
.GetPixels(GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetRight());
8160 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetTop().IsValid())
8161 paddingTop
= converter
.GetPixels(GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetTop());
8162 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetLeft().IsValid())
8163 paddingBottom
= converter
.GetPixels(GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetPadding().GetBottom());
8165 // Assume that left and top padding are also used for inter-cell padding.
8166 int paddingX
= paddingLeft
;
8167 int paddingY
= paddingTop
;
8169 int totalLeftMargin
= 0, totalRightMargin
= 0, totalTopMargin
= 0, totalBottomMargin
= 0;
8170 GetTotalMargin(dc
, buffer
, GetAttributes(), totalLeftMargin
, totalRightMargin
, totalTopMargin
, totalBottomMargin
);
8172 // Internal table width - the area for content
8173 int internalTableWidth
= tableWidth
- totalLeftMargin
- totalRightMargin
;
8175 int rowCount
= m_cells
.GetCount();
8176 if (m_colCount
== 0 || rowCount
== 0)
8178 wxRect
overallRect(rect
.x
, rect
.y
, totalLeftMargin
+ totalRightMargin
, totalTopMargin
+ totalBottomMargin
);
8179 SetCachedSize(overallRect
.GetSize());
8181 // Zero content size
8182 SetMinSize(overallRect
.GetSize());
8183 SetMaxSize(GetMinSize());
8187 // The final calculated widths
8188 wxArrayInt
colWidths(m_colCount
);
8190 wxArrayInt
absoluteColWidths(m_colCount
);
8191 // wxArrayInt absoluteColWidthsSpanning(m_colCount);
8192 wxArrayInt
percentageColWidths(m_colCount
);
8193 // wxArrayInt percentageColWidthsSpanning(m_colCount);
8194 // These are only relevant when the first column contains spanning information.
8195 // wxArrayInt columnSpans(m_colCount); // Each contains 1 for non-spanning cell, > 1 for spanning cell.
8196 wxArrayInt
maxColWidths(m_colCount
);
8197 wxArrayInt
minColWidths(m_colCount
);
8199 wxSize
tableSize(tableWidth
, 0);
8203 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
8205 absoluteColWidths
[i
] = 0;
8206 // absoluteColWidthsSpanning[i] = 0;
8207 percentageColWidths
[i
] = -1;
8208 // percentageColWidthsSpanning[i] = -1;
8210 maxColWidths
[i
] = 0;
8211 minColWidths
[i
] = 0;
8212 // columnSpans[i] = 1;
8215 // (0) Determine which cells are visible according to spans
8217 // __________________
8222 // |------------------|
8223 // |__________________| 4
8225 // To calculate cell visibility:
8226 // First find all spanning cells. Build an array of span records with start x, y and end x, y.
8227 // Then for each cell, test whether we're within one of those cells, and unless we're at the start of
8228 // that cell, hide the cell.
8230 // We can also use this array to match the size of spanning cells to the grid. Or just do
8231 // this when we iterate through all cells.
8233 // 0.1: add spanning cells to an array
8234 wxRichTextRectArray rectArray
;
8235 for (j
= 0; j
< m_rowCount
; j
++)
8237 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
8239 wxRichTextBox
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
8240 int colSpan
= 1, rowSpan
= 1;
8241 if (cell
->GetProperties().HasProperty(wxT("colspan")))
8242 colSpan
= cell
->GetProperties().GetPropertyLong(wxT("colspan"));
8243 if (cell
->GetProperties().HasProperty(wxT("rowspan")))
8244 rowSpan
= cell
->GetProperties().GetPropertyLong(wxT("rowspan"));
8245 if (colSpan
> 1 || rowSpan
> 1)
8247 rectArray
.Add(wxRect(i
, j
, colSpan
, rowSpan
));
8251 // 0.2: find which cells are subsumed by a spanning cell
8252 for (j
= 0; j
< m_rowCount
; j
++)
8254 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
8256 wxRichTextBox
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
8257 if (rectArray
.GetCount() == 0)
8263 int colSpan
= 1, rowSpan
= 1;
8264 if (cell
->GetProperties().HasProperty(wxT("colspan")))
8265 colSpan
= cell
->GetProperties().GetPropertyLong(wxT("colspan"));
8266 if (cell
->GetProperties().HasProperty(wxT("rowspan")))
8267 rowSpan
= cell
->GetProperties().GetPropertyLong(wxT("rowspan"));
8268 if (colSpan
> 1 || rowSpan
> 1)
8270 // Assume all spanning cells are shown
8276 for (k
= 0; k
< (int) rectArray
.GetCount(); k
++)
8278 if (rectArray
[k
].Contains(wxPoint(i
, j
)))
8290 // TODO: find the first spanned cell in each row that spans the most columns and doesn't
8291 // overlap with a spanned cell starting at a previous column position.
8292 // This means we need to keep an array of rects so we can check. However
8293 // it does also mean that some spans simply may not be taken into account
8294 // where there are different spans happening on different rows. In these cases,
8295 // they will simply be as wide as their constituent columns.
8297 // (1) Do an initial layout for all cells to get minimum and maximum size, and get
8298 // the absolute or percentage width of each column.
8300 for (j
= 0; j
< m_rowCount
; j
++)
8302 // First get the overall margins so we can calculate percentage widths based on
8303 // the available content space for all cells on the row
8305 int overallRowContentMargin
= 0;
8306 int visibleCellCount
= 0;
8308 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
8310 wxRichTextBox
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
8311 if (cell
->IsShown())
8313 int cellTotalLeftMargin
= 0, cellTotalRightMargin
= 0, cellTotalTopMargin
= 0, cellTotalBottomMargin
= 0;
8314 GetTotalMargin(dc
, buffer
, cell
->GetAttributes(), cellTotalLeftMargin
, cellTotalRightMargin
, cellTotalTopMargin
, cellTotalBottomMargin
);
8316 overallRowContentMargin
+= (cellTotalLeftMargin
+ cellTotalRightMargin
);
8317 visibleCellCount
++;
8321 // Add in inter-cell padding
8322 overallRowContentMargin
+= ((visibleCellCount
-1) * paddingX
);
8324 int rowContentWidth
= internalTableWidth
- overallRowContentMargin
;
8325 wxSize
rowTableSize(rowContentWidth
, 0);
8326 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, scale
, rowTableSize
);
8328 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
8330 wxRichTextBox
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
8331 if (cell
->IsShown())
8334 if (cell
->GetProperties().HasProperty(wxT("colspan")))
8335 colSpan
= cell
->GetProperties().GetPropertyLong(wxT("colspan"));
8337 // Lay out cell to find min/max widths
8338 cell
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
8339 cell
->Layout(dc
, availableSpace
, style
);
8343 int absoluteCellWidth
= -1;
8344 int percentageCellWidth
= -1;
8346 // I think we need to calculate percentages from the internal table size,
8347 // minus the padding between cells which we'll need to calculate from the
8348 // (number of VISIBLE cells - 1)*paddingX. Then percentages that add up to 100%
8349 // will add up to 100%. In CSS, the width specifies the cell's content rect width,
8350 // so if we want to conform to that we'll need to add in the overall cell margins.
8351 // However, this will make it difficult to specify percentages that add up to
8352 // 100% and still fit within the table width.
8353 // Let's say two cells have 50% width. They have 10 pixels of overall margin each.
8354 // The table content rect is 500 pixels and the inter-cell padding is 20 pixels.
8355 // If we're using internal content size for the width, we would calculate the
8356 // the overall cell width for n cells as:
8357 // (500 - 20*(n-1) - overallCellMargin1 - overallCellMargin2 - ...) * percentage / 100
8358 // + thisOverallCellMargin
8359 // = 500 - 20 - 10 - 10) * 0.5 + 10 = 240 pixels overall cell width.
8360 // Adding this back, we get 240 + 240 + 20 = 500 pixels.
8362 if (cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().IsValid())
8364 int w
= converter
.GetPixels(cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth());
8365 if (cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PERCENTAGE
)
8367 percentageCellWidth
= w
;
8371 absoluteCellWidth
= w
;
8373 // Override absolute width with minimum width if necessary
8374 if (cell
->GetMinSize().x
> 0 && absoluteCellWidth
!=1 && cell
->GetMinSize().x
> absoluteCellWidth
)
8375 absoluteCellWidth
= cell
->GetMinSize().x
;
8378 if (absoluteCellWidth
!= -1)
8380 if (absoluteCellWidth
> absoluteColWidths
[i
])
8381 absoluteColWidths
[i
] = absoluteCellWidth
;
8384 if (percentageCellWidth
!= -1)
8386 if (percentageCellWidth
> percentageColWidths
[i
])
8387 percentageColWidths
[i
] = percentageCellWidth
;
8390 if (colSpan
== 1 && cell
->GetMinSize().x
&& cell
->GetMinSize().x
> minColWidths
[i
])
8391 minColWidths
[i
] = cell
->GetMinSize().x
;
8392 if (colSpan
== 1 && cell
->GetMaxSize().x
&& cell
->GetMaxSize().x
> maxColWidths
[i
])
8393 maxColWidths
[i
] = cell
->GetMaxSize().x
;
8399 // (2) Allocate initial column widths from minimum widths, absolute values and proportions
8400 // TODO: simply merge this into (1).
8401 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
8403 if (absoluteColWidths
[i
] > 0)
8405 colWidths
[i
] = absoluteColWidths
[i
];
8407 else if (percentageColWidths
[i
] > 0)
8409 colWidths
[i
] = percentageColWidths
[i
];
8411 // This is rubbish - we calculated the absolute widths from percentages, so
8412 // we can't do it again here.
8413 //colWidths[i] = (int) (double(percentageColWidths[i]) * double(tableWidth) / 100.0 + 0.5);
8417 // (3) Process absolute or proportional widths of spanning columns,
8418 // now that we know what our fixed column widths are going to be.
8419 // Spanned cells will try to adjust columns so the span will fit.
8420 // Even existing fixed column widths can be expanded if necessary.
8421 // Actually, currently fixed columns widths aren't adjusted; instead,
8422 // the algorithm favours earlier rows and adjusts unspecified column widths
8423 // the first time only. After that, we can't know whether the column has been
8424 // specified explicitly or not. (We could make a note if necessary.)
8425 for (j
= 0; j
< m_rowCount
; j
++)
8427 // First get the overall margins so we can calculate percentage widths based on
8428 // the available content space for all cells on the row
8430 int overallRowContentMargin
= 0;
8431 int visibleCellCount
= 0;
8433 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
8435 wxRichTextBox
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
8436 if (cell
->IsShown())
8438 int cellTotalLeftMargin
= 0, cellTotalRightMargin
= 0, cellTotalTopMargin
= 0, cellTotalBottomMargin
= 0;
8439 GetTotalMargin(dc
, buffer
, cell
->GetAttributes(), cellTotalLeftMargin
, cellTotalRightMargin
, cellTotalTopMargin
, cellTotalBottomMargin
);
8441 overallRowContentMargin
+= (cellTotalLeftMargin
+ cellTotalRightMargin
);
8442 visibleCellCount
++;
8446 // Add in inter-cell padding
8447 overallRowContentMargin
+= ((visibleCellCount
-1) * paddingX
);
8449 int rowContentWidth
= internalTableWidth
- overallRowContentMargin
;
8450 wxSize
rowTableSize(rowContentWidth
, 0);
8451 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, scale
, rowTableSize
);
8453 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
8455 wxRichTextBox
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
8456 if (cell
->IsShown())
8459 if (cell
->GetProperties().HasProperty(wxT("colspan")))
8460 colSpan
= cell
->GetProperties().GetPropertyLong(wxT("colspan"));
8464 int spans
= wxMin(colSpan
, m_colCount
- i
);
8468 if (cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().IsValid())
8470 cellWidth
= converter
.GetPixels(cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth());
8471 // Override absolute width with minimum width if necessary
8472 if (cell
->GetMinSize().x
> 0 && cellWidth
!=1 && cell
->GetMinSize().x
> cellWidth
)
8473 cellWidth
= cell
->GetMinSize().x
;
8477 // Do we want to do this? It's the only chance we get to
8478 // use the cell's min/max sizes, so we need to work out
8479 // how we're going to balance the unspecified spanning cell
8480 // width with the possibility more-constrained constituent cell widths.
8481 // Say there's a tiny bitmap giving it a max width of 10 pixels. We
8482 // don't want to constraint all the spanned columns to fit into this cell.
8483 // OK, let's say that if any of the constituent columns don't fit,
8484 // then we simply stop constraining the columns; instead, we'll just fit the spanning
8485 // cells to the columns later.
8486 cellWidth
= cell
->GetMinSize().x
;
8487 if (cell
->GetMaxSize().x
> cellWidth
)
8488 cellWidth
= cell
->GetMaxSize().x
;
8491 // Subtract the padding between cells
8492 int spanningWidth
= cellWidth
;
8493 spanningWidth
-= paddingX
* (spans
-1);
8495 if (spanningWidth
> 0)
8497 // Now share the spanning width between columns within that span
8498 // TODO: take into account min widths of columns within the span
8499 int spanningWidthLeft
= spanningWidth
;
8500 int stretchColCount
= 0;
8501 for (k
= i
; k
< (i
+spans
); k
++)
8503 if (colWidths
[k
] > 0) // absolute or proportional width has been specified
8504 spanningWidthLeft
-= colWidths
[k
];
8508 // Now divide what's left between the remaining columns
8510 if (stretchColCount
> 0)
8511 colShare
= spanningWidthLeft
/ stretchColCount
;
8512 int colShareRemainder
= spanningWidthLeft
- (colShare
* stretchColCount
);
8514 // If fixed-width columns are currently too big, then we'll later
8515 // stretch the spanned cell to fit.
8517 if (spanningWidthLeft
> 0)
8519 for (k
= i
; k
< (i
+spans
); k
++)
8521 if (colWidths
[k
] <= 0) // absolute or proportional width has not been specified
8523 int newWidth
= colShare
;
8524 if (k
== (i
+spans
-1))
8525 newWidth
+= colShareRemainder
; // ensure all pixels are filled
8526 colWidths
[k
] = newWidth
;
8537 // (4) Next, share any remaining space out between columns that have not yet been calculated.
8538 // TODO: take into account min widths of columns within the span
8539 int tableWidthMinusPadding
= internalTableWidth
- (m_colCount
-1)*paddingX
;
8540 int widthLeft
= tableWidthMinusPadding
;
8541 int stretchColCount
= 0;
8542 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
8544 // TODO: we need to take into account min widths.
8545 // Subtract min width from width left, then
8546 // add the colShare to the min width
8547 if (colWidths
[i
] > 0) // absolute or proportional width has been specified
8548 widthLeft
-= colWidths
[i
];
8551 if (minColWidths
[i
] > 0)
8552 widthLeft
-= minColWidths
[i
];
8558 // Now divide what's left between the remaining columns
8560 if (stretchColCount
> 0)
8561 colShare
= widthLeft
/ stretchColCount
;
8562 int colShareRemainder
= widthLeft
- (colShare
* stretchColCount
);
8564 // Check we don't have enough space, in which case shrink all columns, overriding
8565 // any absolute/proportional widths
8566 // TODO: actually we would like to divide up the shrinkage according to size.
8567 // How do we calculate the proportions that will achieve this?
8568 // Could first choose an arbitrary value for stretching cells, and then calculate
8569 // factors to multiply each width by.
8570 // TODO: want to record this fact and pass to an iteration that tries e.g. min widths
8571 if (widthLeft
< 0 || (stretchToFitTableWidth
&& (stretchColCount
== 0)))
8573 colShare
= tableWidthMinusPadding
/ m_colCount
;
8574 colShareRemainder
= tableWidthMinusPadding
- (colShare
* m_colCount
);
8575 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
8578 minColWidths
[i
] = 0;
8582 // We have to adjust the columns if either we need to shrink the
8583 // table to fit the parent/table width, or we explicitly set the
8584 // table width and need to stretch out the table.
8585 if (widthLeft
< 0 || stretchToFitTableWidth
)
8587 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
8589 if (colWidths
[i
] <= 0) // absolute or proportional width has not been specified
8591 if (minColWidths
[i
] > 0)
8592 colWidths
[i
] = minColWidths
[i
] + colShare
;
8594 colWidths
[i
] = colShare
;
8595 if (i
== (m_colCount
-1))
8596 colWidths
[i
] += colShareRemainder
; // ensure all pixels are filled
8601 // TODO: if spanned cells have no specified or max width, make them the
8602 // as big as the columns they span. Do this for all spanned cells in all
8603 // rows, of course. Size any spanned cells left over at the end - even if they
8604 // have width > 0, make sure they're limited to the appropriate column edge.
8608 Sort out confusion between content width
8609 and overall width later. For now, assume we specify overall width.
8611 So, now we've laid out the table to fit into the given space
8612 and have used specified widths and minimum widths.
8614 Now we need to consider how we will try to take maximum width into account.
8618 // (??) TODO: take max width into account
8620 // (6) Lay out all cells again with the current values
8623 int y
= availableSpace
.y
;
8624 for (j
= 0; j
< m_rowCount
; j
++)
8626 int x
= availableSpace
.x
; // TODO: take into account centering etc.
8627 int maxCellHeight
= 0;
8628 int maxSpecifiedCellHeight
= 0;
8630 wxArrayInt
actualWidths(m_colCount
);
8632 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter
converter(dc
, scale
);
8633 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
8635 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
8636 if (cell
->IsShown())
8638 // Get max specified cell height
8639 // Don't handle percentages for height
8640 if (cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().IsValid() && cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().GetUnits() != wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PERCENTAGE
)
8642 int h
= converter
.GetPixels(cell
->GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight());
8643 if (h
> maxSpecifiedCellHeight
)
8644 maxSpecifiedCellHeight
= h
;
8647 if (colWidths
[i
] > 0) // absolute or proportional width has been specified
8650 if (cell
->GetProperties().HasProperty(wxT("colspan")))
8651 colSpan
= cell
->GetProperties().GetPropertyLong(wxT("colspan"));
8653 wxRect availableCellSpace
;
8655 // TODO: take into acount spans
8658 // Calculate the size of this spanning cell from its constituent columns
8660 int spans
= wxMin(colSpan
, m_colCount
- i
);
8661 for (k
= i
; k
< spans
; k
++)
8667 availableCellSpace
= wxRect(x
, y
, xx
, -1);
8670 availableCellSpace
= wxRect(x
, y
, colWidths
[i
], -1);
8672 // Store actual width so we can force cell to be the appropriate width on the final loop
8673 actualWidths
[i
] = availableCellSpace
.GetWidth();
8676 cell
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
8677 cell
->Layout(dc
, availableCellSpace
, style
);
8679 // TODO: use GetCachedSize().x to compute 'natural' size
8681 x
+= (availableCellSpace
.GetWidth() + paddingX
);
8682 if (cell
->GetCachedSize().y
> maxCellHeight
)
8683 maxCellHeight
= cell
->GetCachedSize().y
;
8688 maxCellHeight
= wxMax(maxCellHeight
, maxSpecifiedCellHeight
);
8690 for (i
= 0; i
< m_colCount
; i
++)
8692 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= GetCell(j
, i
);
8693 if (cell
->IsShown())
8695 wxRect availableCellSpace
= wxRect(cell
->GetPosition(), wxSize(actualWidths
[i
], maxCellHeight
));
8696 // Lay out cell with new height
8697 cell
->Invalidate(wxRICHTEXT_ALL
);
8698 cell
->Layout(dc
, availableCellSpace
, style
);
8700 // Make sure the cell size really is the appropriate size,
8701 // not the calculated box size
8702 cell
->SetCachedSize(wxSize(actualWidths
[i
], maxCellHeight
));
8704 maxRight
= wxMax(maxRight
, cell
->GetPosition().x
+ cell
->GetCachedSize().x
);
8709 if (j
< (m_rowCount
-1))
8713 // We need to add back the margins etc.
8715 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
8716 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0, 0), wxSize(maxRight
- availableSpace
.x
, y
- availableSpace
.y
));
8717 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), GetAttributes(), marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
8718 SetCachedSize(marginRect
.GetSize());
8721 // TODO: calculate max size
8723 SetMaxSize(GetCachedSize());
8726 // TODO: calculate min size
8728 SetMinSize(GetCachedSize());
8731 // TODO: currently we use either a fixed table width or the parent's size.
8732 // We also want to be able to calculate the table width from its content,
8733 // whether using fixed column widths or cell content min/max width.
8734 // Probably need a boolean flag to say whether we need to stretch cells
8735 // to fit the table width, or to simply use min/max cell widths. The
8736 // trouble with this is that if cell widths are not specified, they
8737 // will be tiny; we could use arbitrary defaults but this seems unsatisfactory.
8738 // Anyway, ignoring that problem, we probably need to factor layout into a function
8739 // that can can calculate the maximum unconstrained layout in case table size is
8740 // not specified. Then LayoutToBestSize() can choose to use either parent size to
8741 // constrain Layout(), or the previously-calculated max size to constraint layout.
8746 // Finds the absolute position and row height for the given character position
8747 bool wxRichTextTable::FindPosition(wxDC
& dc
, long index
, wxPoint
& pt
, int* height
, bool forceLineStart
)
8749 wxRichTextCell
* child
= GetCell(index
+1);
8752 // Find the position at the start of the child cell, since the table doesn't
8753 // have any caret position of its own.
8754 return child
->FindPosition(dc
, -1, pt
, height
, forceLineStart
);
8760 // Get the cell at the given character position (in the range of the table).
8761 wxRichTextCell
* wxRichTextTable::GetCell(long pos
) const
8763 int row
= 0, col
= 0;
8764 if (GetCellRowColumnPosition(pos
, row
, col
))
8766 return GetCell(row
, col
);
8772 // Get the row/column for a given character position
8773 bool wxRichTextTable::GetCellRowColumnPosition(long pos
, int& row
, int& col
) const
8775 if (m_colCount
== 0 || m_rowCount
== 0)
8778 row
= (int) (pos
/ m_colCount
);
8779 col
= pos
- (row
* m_colCount
);
8781 wxASSERT(row
< m_rowCount
&& col
< m_colCount
);
8783 if (row
< m_rowCount
&& col
< m_colCount
)
8789 // Calculate range, taking row/cell ordering into account instead of relying
8790 // on list ordering.
8791 void wxRichTextTable::CalculateRange(long start
, long& end
)
8793 long current
= start
;
8794 long lastEnd
= current
;
8803 for (i
= 0; i
< m_rowCount
; i
++)
8805 for (j
= 0; j
< m_colCount
; j
++)
8807 wxRichTextCell
* child
= GetCell(i
, j
);
8812 child
->CalculateRange(current
, childEnd
);
8815 current
= childEnd
+ 1;
8820 // A top-level object always has a range of size 1,
8821 // because its children don't count at this level.
8823 m_range
.SetRange(start
, start
);
8825 // An object with no children has zero length
8826 if (m_children
.GetCount() == 0)
8828 m_ownRange
.SetRange(0, lastEnd
);
8831 // Gets the range size.
8832 bool wxRichTextTable::GetRangeSize(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& descent
, wxDC
& dc
, int flags
, wxPoint position
, wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
) const
8834 return wxRichTextBox::GetRangeSize(range
, size
, descent
, dc
, flags
, position
, partialExtents
);
8837 // Deletes content in the given range.
8838 bool wxRichTextTable::DeleteRange(const wxRichTextRange
& WXUNUSED(range
))
8840 // TODO: implement deletion of cells
8844 // Gets any text in this object for the given range.
8845 wxString
wxRichTextTable::GetTextForRange(const wxRichTextRange
& range
) const
8847 return wxRichTextBox::GetTextForRange(range
);
8850 // Copies this object.
8851 void wxRichTextTable::Copy(const wxRichTextTable
& obj
)
8853 wxRichTextBox::Copy(obj
);
8857 m_rowCount
= obj
.m_rowCount
;
8858 m_colCount
= obj
.m_colCount
;
8860 m_cells
.Add(wxRichTextObjectPtrArray(), m_rowCount
);
8863 for (i
= 0; i
< m_rowCount
; i
++)
8865 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[i
];
8866 for (j
= 0; j
< m_colCount
; j
++)
8868 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= wxDynamicCast(obj
.GetCell(i
, j
)->Clone(), wxRichTextCell
);
8876 void wxRichTextTable::ClearTable()
8882 bool wxRichTextTable::CreateTable(int rows
, int cols
)
8889 m_cells
.Add(wxRichTextObjectPtrArray(), rows
);
8892 for (i
= 0; i
< rows
; i
++)
8894 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[i
];
8895 for (j
= 0; j
< cols
; j
++)
8897 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= new wxRichTextCell
;
8899 cell
->AddParagraph(wxEmptyString
);
8908 wxRichTextCell
* wxRichTextTable::GetCell(int row
, int col
) const
8910 wxASSERT(row
< m_rowCount
);
8911 wxASSERT(col
< m_colCount
);
8913 if (row
< m_rowCount
&& col
< m_colCount
)
8915 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[row
];
8916 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= colArray
[col
];
8917 return wxDynamicCast(obj
, wxRichTextCell
);
8923 // Returns a selection object specifying the selections between start and end character positions.
8924 // For example, a table would deduce what cells (of range length 1) are selected when dragging across the table.
8925 wxRichTextSelection
wxRichTextTable::GetSelection(long start
, long end
) const
8927 wxRichTextSelection selection
;
8928 selection
.SetContainer((wxRichTextTable
*) this);
8937 wxASSERT( start
>= 0 && end
< (m_colCount
* m_rowCount
));
8939 if (end
>= (m_colCount
* m_rowCount
))
8942 // We need to find the rectangle of cells that is described by the rectangle
8943 // with start, end as the diagonal. Make sure we don't add cells that are
8944 // not currenty visible because they are overlapped by spanning cells.
8946 --------------------------
8947 | 0 | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
8948 --------------------------
8949 | 5 | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 |
8950 --------------------------
8951 | 10 | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 |
8952 --------------------------
8953 | 15 | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 |
8954 --------------------------
8956 Let's say we select 6 -> 18.
8958 Left and right edge cols of rectangle are 1 and 3 inclusive. Find least/greatest to find
8959 which is left and which is right.
8961 Top and bottom edge rows are 1 and 3 inclusive. Again, find least/greatest to find top and bottom.
8963 Now go through rows from 1 to 3 and only add cells that are (a) within above column range
8969 int leftCol
= start
- m_colCount
* int(start
/m_colCount
);
8970 int rightCol
= end
- m_colCount
* int(end
/m_colCount
);
8972 int topRow
= int(start
/m_colCount
);
8973 int bottomRow
= int(end
/m_colCount
);
8975 if (leftCol
> rightCol
)
8982 if (topRow
> bottomRow
)
8984 int tmp
= bottomRow
;
8990 for (i
= topRow
; i
<= bottomRow
; i
++)
8992 for (j
= leftCol
; j
<= rightCol
; j
++)
8994 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= GetCell(i
, j
);
8995 if (cell
&& cell
->IsShown())
8996 selection
.Add(cell
->GetRange());
9003 // Sets the attributes for the cells specified by the selection.
9004 bool wxRichTextTable::SetCellStyle(const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
, int flags
)
9006 if (selection
.GetContainer() != this)
9009 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
= GetBuffer();
9010 bool haveControl
= (buffer
&& buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl() != NULL
);
9011 bool withUndo
= haveControl
&& ((flags
& wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
) != 0);
9014 buffer
->BeginBatchUndo(_("Set Cell Style"));
9016 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_children
.GetFirst();
9019 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextCell
);
9020 if (cell
&& selection
.WithinSelection(cell
->GetRange().GetStart()))
9021 SetStyle(cell
, style
, flags
);
9022 node
= node
->GetNext();
9025 // Do action, or delay it until end of batch.
9027 buffer
->EndBatchUndo();
9032 bool wxRichTextTable::DeleteRows(int startRow
, int noRows
)
9034 wxASSERT((startRow
+ noRows
) < m_rowCount
);
9035 if ((startRow
+ noRows
) >= m_rowCount
)
9039 for (i
= startRow
; i
< (startRow
+noRows
); i
++)
9041 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[startRow
];
9042 for (j
= 0; j
< (int) colArray
.GetCount(); j
++)
9044 wxRichTextObject
* cell
= colArray
[j
];
9045 RemoveChild(cell
, true);
9048 // Keep deleting at the same position, since we move all
9050 m_cells
.RemoveAt(startRow
);
9053 m_rowCount
= m_rowCount
- noRows
;
9058 bool wxRichTextTable::DeleteColumns(int startCol
, int noCols
)
9060 wxASSERT((startCol
+ noCols
) < m_colCount
);
9061 if ((startCol
+ noCols
) >= m_colCount
)
9064 bool deleteRows
= (noCols
== m_colCount
);
9067 for (i
= 0; i
< m_rowCount
; i
++)
9069 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[deleteRows
? 0 : i
];
9070 for (j
= startCol
; j
< (startCol
+noCols
); j
++)
9072 wxRichTextObject
* cell
= colArray
[j
];
9073 RemoveChild(cell
, true);
9077 m_cells
.RemoveAt(0);
9082 m_colCount
= m_colCount
- noCols
;
9087 bool wxRichTextTable::AddRows(int startRow
, int noRows
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
)
9089 wxASSERT(startRow
<= m_rowCount
);
9090 if (startRow
> m_rowCount
)
9094 for (i
= 0; i
< noRows
; i
++)
9097 if (startRow
== m_rowCount
)
9099 m_cells
.Add(wxRichTextObjectPtrArray());
9100 idx
= m_cells
.GetCount() - 1;
9104 m_cells
.Insert(wxRichTextObjectPtrArray(), startRow
+i
);
9108 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[idx
];
9109 for (j
= 0; j
< m_colCount
; j
++)
9111 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= new wxRichTextCell
;
9112 cell
->GetAttributes() = attr
;
9119 m_rowCount
= m_rowCount
+ noRows
;
9123 bool wxRichTextTable::AddColumns(int startCol
, int noCols
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
)
9125 wxASSERT(startCol
<= m_colCount
);
9126 if (startCol
> m_colCount
)
9130 for (i
= 0; i
< m_rowCount
; i
++)
9132 wxRichTextObjectPtrArray
& colArray
= m_cells
[i
];
9133 for (j
= 0; j
< noCols
; j
++)
9135 wxRichTextCell
* cell
= new wxRichTextCell
;
9136 cell
->GetAttributes() = attr
;
9140 if (startCol
== m_colCount
)
9143 colArray
.Insert(cell
, startCol
+j
);
9147 m_colCount
= m_colCount
+ noCols
;
9152 // Edit properties via a GUI
9153 bool wxRichTextTable::EditProperties(wxWindow
* parent
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
)
9155 wxRichTextObjectPropertiesDialog
boxDlg(this, wxGetTopLevelParent(parent
), wxID_ANY
, _("Table Properties"));
9156 boxDlg
.SetAttributes(GetAttributes());
9158 if (boxDlg
.ShowModal() == wxID_OK
)
9160 boxDlg
.ApplyStyle(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl(), wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
|wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET
);
9168 * Module to initialise and clean up handlers
9171 class wxRichTextModule
: public wxModule
9173 DECLARE_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextModule
)
9175 wxRichTextModule() {}
9178 wxRichTextBuffer::SetRenderer(new wxRichTextStdRenderer
);
9179 wxRichTextBuffer::InitStandardHandlers();
9180 wxRichTextParagraph::InitDefaultTabs();
9185 wxRichTextBuffer::CleanUpHandlers();
9186 wxRichTextDecimalToRoman(-1);
9187 wxRichTextParagraph::ClearDefaultTabs();
9188 wxRichTextCtrl::ClearAvailableFontNames();
9189 wxRichTextBuffer::SetRenderer(NULL
);
9193 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextModule
, wxModule
)
9196 // If the richtext lib is dynamically loaded after the app has already started
9197 // (such as from wxPython) then the built-in module system will not init this
9198 // module. Provide this function to do it manually.
9199 void wxRichTextModuleInit()
9201 wxModule
* module = new wxRichTextModule
;
9203 wxModule::RegisterModule(module);
9208 * Commands for undo/redo
9212 wxRichTextCommand::wxRichTextCommand(const wxString
& name
, wxRichTextCommandId id
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
,
9213 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
, wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, bool ignoreFirstTime
): wxCommand(true, name
)
9215 /* wxRichTextAction* action = */ new wxRichTextAction(this, name
, id
, buffer
, container
, ctrl
, ignoreFirstTime
);
9218 wxRichTextCommand::wxRichTextCommand(const wxString
& name
): wxCommand(true, name
)
9222 wxRichTextCommand::~wxRichTextCommand()
9227 void wxRichTextCommand::AddAction(wxRichTextAction
* action
)
9229 if (!m_actions
.Member(action
))
9230 m_actions
.Append(action
);
9233 bool wxRichTextCommand::Do()
9235 for (wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_actions
.GetFirst(); node
; node
= node
->GetNext())
9237 wxRichTextAction
* action
= (wxRichTextAction
*) node
->GetData();
9244 bool wxRichTextCommand::Undo()
9246 for (wxList::compatibility_iterator node
= m_actions
.GetLast(); node
; node
= node
->GetPrevious())
9248 wxRichTextAction
* action
= (wxRichTextAction
*) node
->GetData();
9255 void wxRichTextCommand::ClearActions()
9257 WX_CLEAR_LIST(wxList
, m_actions
);
9265 wxRichTextAction::wxRichTextAction(wxRichTextCommand
* cmd
, const wxString
& name
, wxRichTextCommandId id
,
9266 wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
, wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
,
9267 wxRichTextCtrl
* ctrl
, bool ignoreFirstTime
)
9271 m_containerAddress
.Create(buffer
, container
);
9272 m_ignoreThis
= ignoreFirstTime
;
9277 m_newParagraphs
.SetDefaultStyle(buffer
->GetDefaultStyle());
9278 m_newParagraphs
.SetBasicStyle(buffer
->GetBasicStyle());
9280 cmd
->AddAction(this);
9283 wxRichTextAction::~wxRichTextAction()
9289 // Returns the container that this action refers to, using the container address and top-level buffer.
9290 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* wxRichTextAction::GetContainer() const
9292 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= wxDynamicCast(GetContainerAddress().GetObject(m_buffer
), wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
);
9297 void wxRichTextAction::CalculateRefreshOptimizations(wxArrayInt
& optimizationLineCharPositions
, wxArrayInt
& optimizationLineYPositions
)
9299 // Store a list of line start character and y positions so we can figure out which area
9300 // we need to refresh
9302 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING
9303 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= GetContainer();
9304 wxASSERT(container
!= NULL
);
9308 // NOTE: we're assuming that the buffer is laid out correctly at this point.
9309 // If we had several actions, which only invalidate and leave layout until the
9310 // paint handler is called, then this might not be true. So we may need to switch
9311 // optimisation on only when we're simply adding text and not simultaneously
9312 // deleting a selection, for example. Or, we make sure the buffer is laid out correctly
9313 // first, but of course this means we'll be doing it twice.
9314 if (!m_buffer
->IsDirty() && m_ctrl
) // can only do optimisation if the buffer is already laid out correctly
9316 wxSize clientSize
= m_ctrl
->GetClientSize();
9317 wxPoint firstVisiblePt
= m_ctrl
->GetFirstVisiblePoint();
9318 int lastY
= firstVisiblePt
.y
+ clientSize
.y
;
9320 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= container
->GetParagraphAtPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
9321 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= container
->GetChildren().Find(para
);
9324 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= (wxRichTextParagraph
*) node
->GetData();
9325 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node2
= child
->GetLines().GetFirst();
9328 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node2
->GetData();
9329 wxPoint pt
= line
->GetAbsolutePosition();
9330 wxRichTextRange range
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
9334 node2
= wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator();
9335 node
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
9337 else if (range
.GetStart() > GetPosition() && pt
.y
>= firstVisiblePt
.y
)
9339 optimizationLineCharPositions
.Add(range
.GetStart());
9340 optimizationLineYPositions
.Add(pt
.y
);
9344 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
9348 node
= node
->GetNext();
9354 bool wxRichTextAction::Do()
9356 m_buffer
->Modify(true);
9358 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= GetContainer();
9359 wxASSERT(container
!= NULL
);
9365 case wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
:
9367 // Store a list of line start character and y positions so we can figure out which area
9368 // we need to refresh
9369 wxArrayInt optimizationLineCharPositions
;
9370 wxArrayInt optimizationLineYPositions
;
9372 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING
9373 CalculateRefreshOptimizations(optimizationLineCharPositions
, optimizationLineYPositions
);
9376 container
->InsertFragment(GetRange().GetStart(), m_newParagraphs
);
9377 container
->UpdateRanges();
9379 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
9380 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
9381 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(wxRichTextRange(wxMax(0, GetRange().GetStart()-1), GetRange().GetEnd()));
9383 long newCaretPosition
= GetPosition() + m_newParagraphs
.GetOwnRange().GetLength();
9385 // Character position to caret position
9386 newCaretPosition
--;
9388 // Don't take into account the last newline
9389 if (m_newParagraphs
.GetPartialParagraph())
9390 newCaretPosition
--;
9392 if (m_newParagraphs
.GetChildren().GetCount() > 1)
9394 wxRichTextObject
* p
= (wxRichTextObject
*) m_newParagraphs
.GetChildren().GetLast()->GetData();
9395 if (p
->GetRange().GetLength() == 1)
9396 newCaretPosition
--;
9399 newCaretPosition
= wxMin(newCaretPosition
, (container
->GetOwnRange().GetEnd()-1));
9401 UpdateAppearance(newCaretPosition
, true /* send update event */, & optimizationLineCharPositions
, & optimizationLineYPositions
, true /* do */);
9403 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
9404 wxEVT_COMMAND_RICHTEXT_CONTENT_INSERTED
,
9405 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
9406 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
9407 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
9408 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
9409 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
9411 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
9415 case wxRICHTEXT_DELETE
:
9417 wxArrayInt optimizationLineCharPositions
;
9418 wxArrayInt optimizationLineYPositions
;
9420 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING
9421 CalculateRefreshOptimizations(optimizationLineCharPositions
, optimizationLineYPositions
);
9424 container
->DeleteRange(GetRange());
9425 container
->UpdateRanges();
9426 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
9427 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
9428 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(wxRichTextRange(GetRange().GetStart(), GetRange().GetStart()));
9430 long caretPos
= GetRange().GetStart()-1;
9431 if (caretPos
>= container
->GetOwnRange().GetEnd())
9434 UpdateAppearance(caretPos
, true /* send update event */, & optimizationLineCharPositions
, & optimizationLineYPositions
, true /* do */);
9436 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
9437 wxEVT_COMMAND_RICHTEXT_CONTENT_DELETED
,
9438 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
9439 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
9440 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
9441 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
9442 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
9444 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
9448 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_STYLE
:
9450 ApplyParagraphs(GetNewParagraphs());
9452 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
9453 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
9454 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(GetRange());
9456 UpdateAppearance(GetPosition());
9458 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
9459 wxEVT_COMMAND_RICHTEXT_STYLE_CHANGED
,
9460 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
9461 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
9462 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
9463 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
9464 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
9466 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
9470 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_ATTRIBUTES
:
9472 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= m_objectAddress
.GetObject(m_buffer
); // container->GetChildAtPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
9475 wxRichTextAttr oldAttr
= obj
->GetAttributes();
9476 obj
->GetAttributes() = m_attributes
;
9477 m_attributes
= oldAttr
;
9480 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
9481 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
9482 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(GetRange());
9484 UpdateAppearance(GetPosition());
9486 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
9487 wxEVT_COMMAND_RICHTEXT_STYLE_CHANGED
,
9488 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
9489 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
9490 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
9491 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
9492 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
9494 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
9498 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_OBJECT
:
9500 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= m_objectAddress
.GetObject(m_buffer
);
9501 // wxRichTextObject* obj = container->GetChildAtPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
9502 if (obj
&& m_object
)
9504 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= container
->GetChildren().Find(obj
);
9507 wxRichTextObject
* obj
= node
->GetData();
9508 node
->SetData(m_object
);
9513 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
9514 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
9515 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(GetRange());
9517 UpdateAppearance(GetPosition());
9519 // TODO: send new kind of modification event
9530 bool wxRichTextAction::Undo()
9532 m_buffer
->Modify(true);
9534 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= GetContainer();
9535 wxASSERT(container
!= NULL
);
9541 case wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
:
9543 wxArrayInt optimizationLineCharPositions
;
9544 wxArrayInt optimizationLineYPositions
;
9546 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING
9547 CalculateRefreshOptimizations(optimizationLineCharPositions
, optimizationLineYPositions
);
9550 container
->DeleteRange(GetRange());
9551 container
->UpdateRanges();
9552 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
9553 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
9554 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(wxRichTextRange(GetRange().GetStart(), GetRange().GetStart()));
9556 long newCaretPosition
= GetPosition() - 1;
9558 UpdateAppearance(newCaretPosition
, true, /* send update event */ & optimizationLineCharPositions
, & optimizationLineYPositions
, false /* undo */);
9560 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
9561 wxEVT_COMMAND_RICHTEXT_CONTENT_DELETED
,
9562 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
9563 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
9564 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
9565 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
9566 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
9568 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
9572 case wxRICHTEXT_DELETE
:
9574 wxArrayInt optimizationLineCharPositions
;
9575 wxArrayInt optimizationLineYPositions
;
9577 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING
9578 CalculateRefreshOptimizations(optimizationLineCharPositions
, optimizationLineYPositions
);
9581 container
->InsertFragment(GetRange().GetStart(), m_oldParagraphs
);
9582 container
->UpdateRanges();
9583 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
9584 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
9585 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(GetRange());
9587 UpdateAppearance(GetPosition(), true, /* send update event */ & optimizationLineCharPositions
, & optimizationLineYPositions
, false /* undo */);
9589 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
9590 wxEVT_COMMAND_RICHTEXT_CONTENT_INSERTED
,
9591 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
9592 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
9593 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
9594 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
9595 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
9597 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
9601 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_STYLE
:
9603 ApplyParagraphs(GetOldParagraphs());
9604 // InvalidateHierarchy goes up the hierarchy as well as down, otherwise with a nested object,
9605 // Layout() would stop prematurely at the top level.
9606 container
->InvalidateHierarchy(GetRange());
9608 UpdateAppearance(GetPosition());
9610 wxRichTextEvent
cmdEvent(
9611 wxEVT_COMMAND_RICHTEXT_STYLE_CHANGED
,
9612 m_ctrl
? m_ctrl
->GetId() : -1);
9613 cmdEvent
.SetEventObject(m_ctrl
? (wxObject
*) m_ctrl
: (wxObject
*) m_buffer
);
9614 cmdEvent
.SetRange(GetRange());
9615 cmdEvent
.SetPosition(GetRange().GetStart());
9616 cmdEvent
.SetContainer(container
);
9618 m_buffer
->SendEvent(cmdEvent
);
9622 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_ATTRIBUTES
:
9623 case wxRICHTEXT_CHANGE_OBJECT
:
9634 /// Update the control appearance
9635 void wxRichTextAction::UpdateAppearance(long caretPosition
, bool sendUpdateEvent
, wxArrayInt
* optimizationLineCharPositions
, wxArrayInt
* optimizationLineYPositions
, bool isDoCmd
)
9637 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= GetContainer();
9638 wxASSERT(container
!= NULL
);
9644 m_ctrl
->SetFocusObject(container
);
9645 m_ctrl
->SetCaretPosition(caretPosition
);
9647 if (!m_ctrl
->IsFrozen())
9649 wxRect containerRect
= container
->GetRect();
9651 m_ctrl
->LayoutContent();
9653 // Refresh everything if there were floating objects or the container changed size
9654 // (we can't yet optimize in these cases, since more complex interaction with other content occurs)
9655 if (container
->GetFloatingObjectCount() > 0 || (container
->GetParent() && containerRect
!= container
->GetRect()))
9657 m_ctrl
->Refresh(false);
9661 #if wxRICHTEXT_USE_OPTIMIZED_DRAWING
9662 // Find refresh rectangle if we are in a position to optimise refresh
9663 if ((m_cmdId
== wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
|| m_cmdId
== wxRICHTEXT_DELETE
) && optimizationLineCharPositions
)
9667 wxSize clientSize
= m_ctrl
->GetClientSize();
9668 wxPoint firstVisiblePt
= m_ctrl
->GetFirstVisiblePoint();
9670 // Start/end positions
9672 int lastY
= firstVisiblePt
.y
+ clientSize
.y
;
9674 bool foundEnd
= false;
9676 // position offset - how many characters were inserted
9677 int positionOffset
= GetRange().GetLength();
9679 // Determine whether this is Do or Undo, and adjust positionOffset accordingly
9680 if ((m_cmdId
== wxRICHTEXT_DELETE
&& isDoCmd
) || (m_cmdId
== wxRICHTEXT_INSERT
&& !isDoCmd
))
9681 positionOffset
= - positionOffset
;
9683 // find the first line which is being drawn at the same position as it was
9684 // before. Since we're talking about a simple insertion, we can assume
9685 // that the rest of the window does not need to be redrawn.
9687 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= container
->GetParagraphAtPosition(GetPosition());
9688 // Since we support floating layout, we should redraw the whole para instead of just
9689 // the first line touching the invalid range.
9692 firstY
= para
->GetPosition().y
;
9695 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= container
->GetChildren().Find(para
);
9698 wxRichTextParagraph
* child
= (wxRichTextParagraph
*) node
->GetData();
9699 wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator node2
= child
->GetLines().GetFirst();
9702 wxRichTextLine
* line
= node2
->GetData();
9703 wxPoint pt
= line
->GetAbsolutePosition();
9704 wxRichTextRange range
= line
->GetAbsoluteRange();
9706 // we want to find the first line that is in the same position
9707 // as before. This will mean we're at the end of the changed text.
9709 if (pt
.y
> lastY
) // going past the end of the window, no more info
9711 node2
= wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator();
9712 node
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
9714 // Detect last line in the buffer
9715 else if (!node2
->GetNext() && para
->GetRange().Contains(container
->GetOwnRange().GetEnd()))
9717 // If deleting text, make sure we refresh below as well as above
9718 if (positionOffset
>= 0)
9721 lastY
= pt
.y
+ line
->GetSize().y
;
9724 node2
= wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator();
9725 node
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
9731 // search for this line being at the same position as before
9732 for (i
= 0; i
< optimizationLineCharPositions
->GetCount(); i
++)
9734 if (((*optimizationLineCharPositions
)[i
] + positionOffset
== range
.GetStart()) &&
9735 ((*optimizationLineYPositions
)[i
] == pt
.y
))
9737 // Stop, we're now the same as we were
9742 node2
= wxRichTextLineList::compatibility_iterator();
9743 node
= wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator();
9751 node2
= node2
->GetNext();
9755 node
= node
->GetNext();
9758 firstY
= wxMax(firstVisiblePt
.y
, firstY
);
9760 lastY
= firstVisiblePt
.y
+ clientSize
.y
;
9762 // Convert to device coordinates
9763 wxRect
rect(m_ctrl
->GetPhysicalPoint(wxPoint(firstVisiblePt
.x
, firstY
)), wxSize(clientSize
.x
, lastY
- firstY
));
9764 m_ctrl
->RefreshRect(rect
);
9768 m_ctrl
->Refresh(false);
9770 m_ctrl
->PositionCaret();
9772 // This causes styles to persist when doing programmatic
9773 // content creation except when Freeze/Thaw is used, so
9774 // disable this and check for the consequences.
9775 // m_ctrl->SetDefaultStyleToCursorStyle();
9777 if (sendUpdateEvent
)
9778 wxTextCtrl::SendTextUpdatedEvent(m_ctrl
);
9783 /// Replace the buffer paragraphs with the new ones.
9784 void wxRichTextAction::ApplyParagraphs(const wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
& fragment
)
9786 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= GetContainer();
9787 wxASSERT(container
!= NULL
);
9791 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator node
= fragment
.GetChildren().GetFirst();
9794 wxRichTextParagraph
* para
= wxDynamicCast(node
->GetData(), wxRichTextParagraph
);
9795 wxASSERT (para
!= NULL
);
9797 // We'll replace the existing paragraph by finding the paragraph at this position,
9798 // delete its node data, and setting a copy as the new node data.
9799 // TODO: make more efficient by simply swapping old and new paragraph objects.
9801 wxRichTextParagraph
* existingPara
= container
->GetParagraphAtPosition(para
->GetRange().GetStart());
9804 wxRichTextObjectList::compatibility_iterator bufferParaNode
= container
->GetChildren().Find(existingPara
);
9807 wxRichTextParagraph
* newPara
= new wxRichTextParagraph(*para
);
9808 newPara
->SetParent(container
);
9810 bufferParaNode
->SetData(newPara
);
9812 delete existingPara
;
9816 node
= node
->GetNext();
9823 * This stores beginning and end positions for a range of data.
9826 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxRichTextRangeArray
);
9828 /// Limit this range to be within 'range'
9829 bool wxRichTextRange::LimitTo(const wxRichTextRange
& range
)
9831 if (m_start
< range
.m_start
)
9832 m_start
= range
.m_start
;
9834 if (m_end
> range
.m_end
)
9835 m_end
= range
.m_end
;
9841 * wxRichTextImage implementation
9842 * This object represents an image.
9845 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextImage
, wxRichTextObject
)
9847 wxRichTextImage::wxRichTextImage(const wxImage
& image
, wxRichTextObject
* parent
, wxRichTextAttr
* charStyle
):
9848 wxRichTextObject(parent
)
9850 m_imageBlock
.MakeImageBlockDefaultQuality(image
, wxBITMAP_TYPE_PNG
);
9852 SetAttributes(*charStyle
);
9855 wxRichTextImage::wxRichTextImage(const wxRichTextImageBlock
& imageBlock
, wxRichTextObject
* parent
, wxRichTextAttr
* charStyle
):
9856 wxRichTextObject(parent
)
9858 m_imageBlock
= imageBlock
;
9860 SetAttributes(*charStyle
);
9863 /// Create a cached image at the required size
9864 bool wxRichTextImage::LoadImageCache(wxDC
& dc
, bool resetCache
)
9866 if (resetCache
|| !m_imageCache
.IsOk() /* || m_imageCache.GetWidth() != size.x || m_imageCache.GetHeight() != size.y */)
9868 if (!m_imageBlock
.IsOk())
9872 m_imageBlock
.Load(image
);
9876 int width
= image
.GetWidth();
9877 int height
= image
.GetHeight();
9879 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().IsValid() && GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetValue() > 0)
9881 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
9882 width
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetValue());
9884 width
= GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetWidth().GetValue();
9886 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().IsValid() && GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().GetValue() > 0)
9888 if (GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
9889 height
= ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dc
, GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().GetValue());
9891 height
= GetAttributes().GetTextBoxAttr().GetHeight().GetValue();
9894 if (image
.GetWidth() == width
&& image
.GetHeight() == height
)
9895 m_imageCache
= wxBitmap(image
);
9898 // If the original width and height is small, e.g. 400 or below,
9899 // scale up and then down to improve image quality. This can make
9900 // a big difference, with not much performance hit.
9901 int upscaleThreshold
= 400;
9903 if (image
.GetWidth() <= upscaleThreshold
|| image
.GetHeight() <= upscaleThreshold
)
9905 img
= image
.Scale(image
.GetWidth()*2, image
.GetHeight()*2);
9906 img
.Rescale(width
, height
, wxIMAGE_QUALITY_HIGH
);
9909 img
= image
.Scale(width
, height
, wxIMAGE_QUALITY_HIGH
);
9910 m_imageCache
= wxBitmap(img
);
9914 return m_imageCache
.IsOk();
9918 bool wxRichTextImage::Draw(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextSelection
& selection
, const wxRect
& rect
, int WXUNUSED(descent
), int WXUNUSED(style
))
9923 // Don't need cached size AFAIK
9924 // wxSize size = GetCachedSize();
9925 if (!LoadImageCache(dc
))
9928 DrawBoxAttributes(dc
, GetBuffer(), GetAttributes(), wxRect(GetPosition(), GetCachedSize()));
9931 int y
= rect
.y
+ (rect
.height
- m_imageCache
.GetHeight());
9933 dc
.DrawBitmap(m_imageCache
, rect
.x
, y
, true);
9936 wxSize
imageSize(m_imageCache
.GetWidth(), m_imageCache
.GetHeight());
9937 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
9938 marginRect
= rect
; // outer rectangle, will calculate contentRect
9939 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), GetAttributes(), marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
9941 dc
.DrawBitmap(m_imageCache
, contentRect
.x
, contentRect
.y
, true);
9943 if (selection
.WithinSelection(range
.GetStart(), this))
9945 wxCheckSetBrush(dc
, *wxBLACK_BRUSH
);
9946 wxCheckSetPen(dc
, *wxBLACK_PEN
);
9947 dc
.SetLogicalFunction(wxINVERT
);
9948 dc
.DrawRectangle(contentRect
);
9949 dc
.SetLogicalFunction(wxCOPY
);
9955 /// Lay the item out
9956 bool wxRichTextImage::Layout(wxDC
& dc
, const wxRect
& rect
, int WXUNUSED(style
))
9958 if (!LoadImageCache(dc
))
9961 wxSize
imageSize(m_imageCache
.GetWidth(), m_imageCache
.GetHeight());
9962 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
9963 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0,0), imageSize
);
9964 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), GetAttributes(), marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
9966 wxSize overallSize
= marginRect
.GetSize();
9968 SetCachedSize(overallSize
);
9969 SetMaxSize(overallSize
);
9970 SetMinSize(overallSize
);
9971 SetPosition(rect
.GetPosition());
9976 /// Get/set the object size for the given range. Returns false if the range
9977 /// is invalid for this object.
9978 bool wxRichTextImage::GetRangeSize(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, wxSize
& size
, int& WXUNUSED(descent
), wxDC
& dc
, int WXUNUSED(flags
), wxPoint
WXUNUSED(position
), wxArrayInt
* partialExtents
) const
9980 if (!range
.IsWithin(GetRange()))
9983 if (!((wxRichTextImage
*)this)->LoadImageCache(dc
))
9985 size
.x
= 0; size
.y
= 0;
9987 partialExtents
->Add(0);
9991 wxSize
imageSize(m_imageCache
.GetWidth(), m_imageCache
.GetHeight());
9992 wxRect marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
;
9993 contentRect
= wxRect(wxPoint(0,0), imageSize
);
9994 GetBoxRects(dc
, GetBuffer(), GetAttributes(), marginRect
, borderRect
, contentRect
, paddingRect
, outlineRect
);
9996 wxSize overallSize
= marginRect
.GetSize();
9999 partialExtents
->Add(overallSize
.x
);
10001 size
= overallSize
;
10006 // Get the 'natural' size for an object. For an image, it would be the
10008 wxTextAttrSize
wxRichTextImage::GetNaturalSize() const
10010 wxTextAttrSize size
;
10011 if (GetImageCache().IsOk())
10013 size
.SetWidth(GetImageCache().GetWidth(), wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
10014 size
.SetHeight(GetImageCache().GetHeight(), wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
);
10021 void wxRichTextImage::Copy(const wxRichTextImage
& obj
)
10023 wxRichTextObject::Copy(obj
);
10025 m_imageBlock
= obj
.m_imageBlock
;
10028 /// Edit properties via a GUI
10029 bool wxRichTextImage::EditProperties(wxWindow
* parent
, wxRichTextBuffer
* buffer
)
10031 wxRichTextObjectPropertiesDialog
imageDlg(this, wxGetTopLevelParent(parent
), wxID_ANY
, _("Picture Properties"));
10032 imageDlg
.SetAttributes(GetAttributes());
10034 if (imageDlg
.ShowModal() == wxID_OK
)
10036 // By passing wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET, indeterminate attributes set by the user will be set as
10037 // indeterminate in the object.
10038 imageDlg
.ApplyStyle(buffer
->GetRichTextCtrl(), wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_WITH_UNDO
|wxRICHTEXT_SETSTYLE_RESET
);
10050 /// Compare two attribute objects
10051 bool wxTextAttrEq(const wxRichTextAttr
& attr1
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr2
)
10053 return (attr1
== attr2
);
10056 // Partial equality test taking flags into account
10057 bool wxTextAttrEqPartial(const wxRichTextAttr
& attr1
, const wxRichTextAttr
& attr2
)
10059 return attr1
.EqPartial(attr2
);
10063 bool wxRichTextTabsEq(const wxArrayInt
& tabs1
, const wxArrayInt
& tabs2
)
10065 if (tabs1
.GetCount() != tabs2
.GetCount())
10069 for (i
= 0; i
< tabs1
.GetCount(); i
++)
10071 if (tabs1
[i
] != tabs2
[i
])
10077 bool wxRichTextApplyStyle(wxRichTextAttr
& destStyle
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
, wxRichTextAttr
* compareWith
)
10079 return destStyle
.Apply(style
, compareWith
);
10082 // Remove attributes
10083 bool wxRichTextRemoveStyle(wxRichTextAttr
& destStyle
, const wxRichTextAttr
& style
)
10085 return destStyle
.RemoveStyle(style
);
10088 /// Combine two bitlists, specifying the bits of interest with separate flags.
10089 bool wxRichTextCombineBitlists(int& valueA
, int valueB
, int& flagsA
, int flagsB
)
10091 return wxRichTextAttr::CombineBitlists(valueA
, valueB
, flagsA
, flagsB
);
10094 /// Compare two bitlists
10095 bool wxRichTextBitlistsEqPartial(int valueA
, int valueB
, int flags
)
10097 return wxRichTextAttr::BitlistsEqPartial(valueA
, valueB
, flags
);
10100 /// Split into paragraph and character styles
10101 bool wxRichTextSplitParaCharStyles(const wxRichTextAttr
& style
, wxRichTextAttr
& parStyle
, wxRichTextAttr
& charStyle
)
10103 return wxRichTextAttr::SplitParaCharStyles(style
, parStyle
, charStyle
);
10106 /// Convert a decimal to Roman numerals
10107 wxString
wxRichTextDecimalToRoman(long n
)
10109 static wxArrayInt decimalNumbers
;
10110 static wxArrayString romanNumbers
;
10115 decimalNumbers
.Clear();
10116 romanNumbers
.Clear();
10117 return wxEmptyString
;
10120 if (decimalNumbers
.GetCount() == 0)
10122 #define wxRichTextAddDecRom(n, r) decimalNumbers.Add(n); romanNumbers.Add(r);
10124 wxRichTextAddDecRom(1000, wxT("M"));
10125 wxRichTextAddDecRom(900, wxT("CM"));
10126 wxRichTextAddDecRom(500, wxT("D"));
10127 wxRichTextAddDecRom(400, wxT("CD"));
10128 wxRichTextAddDecRom(100, wxT("C"));
10129 wxRichTextAddDecRom(90, wxT("XC"));
10130 wxRichTextAddDecRom(50, wxT("L"));
10131 wxRichTextAddDecRom(40, wxT("XL"));
10132 wxRichTextAddDecRom(10, wxT("X"));
10133 wxRichTextAddDecRom(9, wxT("IX"));
10134 wxRichTextAddDecRom(5, wxT("V"));
10135 wxRichTextAddDecRom(4, wxT("IV"));
10136 wxRichTextAddDecRom(1, wxT("I"));
10142 while (n
> 0 && i
< 13)
10144 if (n
>= decimalNumbers
[i
])
10146 n
-= decimalNumbers
[i
];
10147 roman
+= romanNumbers
[i
];
10154 if (roman
.IsEmpty())
10160 * wxRichTextFileHandler
10161 * Base class for file handlers
10164 IMPLEMENT_CLASS(wxRichTextFileHandler
, wxObject
)
10166 #if wxUSE_FFILE && wxUSE_STREAMS
10167 bool wxRichTextFileHandler::LoadFile(wxRichTextBuffer
*buffer
, const wxString
& filename
)
10169 wxFFileInputStream
stream(filename
);
10171 return LoadFile(buffer
, stream
);
10176 bool wxRichTextFileHandler::SaveFile(wxRichTextBuffer
*buffer
, const wxString
& filename
)
10178 wxFFileOutputStream
stream(filename
);
10180 return SaveFile(buffer
, stream
);
10184 #endif // wxUSE_FFILE && wxUSE_STREAMS
10186 /// Can we handle this filename (if using files)? By default, checks the extension.
10187 bool wxRichTextFileHandler::CanHandle(const wxString
& filename
) const
10189 wxString path
, file
, ext
;
10190 wxFileName::SplitPath(filename
, & path
, & file
, & ext
);
10192 return (ext
.Lower() == GetExtension());
10196 * wxRichTextTextHandler
10197 * Plain text handler
10200 IMPLEMENT_CLASS(wxRichTextPlainTextHandler
, wxRichTextFileHandler
)
10203 bool wxRichTextPlainTextHandler::DoLoadFile(wxRichTextBuffer
*buffer
, wxInputStream
& stream
)
10205 if (!stream
.IsOk())
10211 while (!stream
.Eof())
10213 int ch
= stream
.GetC();
10217 if (ch
== 10 && lastCh
!= 13)
10220 if (ch
> 0 && ch
!= 10)
10227 buffer
->ResetAndClearCommands();
10229 buffer
->AddParagraphs(str
);
10230 buffer
->UpdateRanges();
10235 bool wxRichTextPlainTextHandler::DoSaveFile(wxRichTextBuffer
*buffer
, wxOutputStream
& stream
)
10237 if (!stream
.IsOk())
10240 wxString text
= buffer
->GetText();
10242 wxString newLine
= wxRichTextLineBreakChar
;
10243 text
.Replace(newLine
, wxT("\n"));
10245 wxCharBuffer buf
= text
.ToAscii();
10247 stream
.Write((const char*) buf
, text
.length());
10250 #endif // wxUSE_STREAMS
10253 * Stores information about an image, in binary in-memory form
10256 wxRichTextImageBlock::wxRichTextImageBlock()
10261 wxRichTextImageBlock::wxRichTextImageBlock(const wxRichTextImageBlock
& block
):wxObject()
10267 wxRichTextImageBlock::~wxRichTextImageBlock()
10272 void wxRichTextImageBlock::Init()
10276 m_imageType
= wxBITMAP_TYPE_INVALID
;
10279 void wxRichTextImageBlock::Clear()
10283 m_imageType
= wxBITMAP_TYPE_INVALID
;
10287 // Load the original image into a memory block.
10288 // If the image is not a JPEG, we must convert it into a JPEG
10289 // to conserve space.
10290 // If it's not a JPEG we can make use of 'image', already scaled, so we don't have to
10291 // load the image a 2nd time.
10293 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::MakeImageBlock(const wxString
& filename
, wxBitmapType imageType
,
10294 wxImage
& image
, bool convertToJPEG
)
10296 m_imageType
= imageType
;
10298 wxString
filenameToRead(filename
);
10299 bool removeFile
= false;
10301 if (imageType
== wxBITMAP_TYPE_INVALID
)
10302 return false; // Could not determine image type
10304 if ((imageType
!= wxBITMAP_TYPE_JPEG
) && convertToJPEG
)
10306 wxString tempFile
=
10307 wxFileName::CreateTempFileName(_("image"));
10309 wxASSERT(!tempFile
.IsEmpty());
10311 image
.SaveFile(tempFile
, wxBITMAP_TYPE_JPEG
);
10312 filenameToRead
= tempFile
;
10315 m_imageType
= wxBITMAP_TYPE_JPEG
;
10318 if (!file
.Open(filenameToRead
))
10321 m_dataSize
= (size_t) file
.Length();
10326 m_data
= ReadBlock(filenameToRead
, m_dataSize
);
10329 wxRemoveFile(filenameToRead
);
10331 return (m_data
!= NULL
);
10334 // Make an image block from the wxImage in the given
10336 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::MakeImageBlock(wxImage
& image
, wxBitmapType imageType
, int quality
)
10338 image
.SetOption(wxT("quality"), quality
);
10340 if (imageType
== wxBITMAP_TYPE_INVALID
)
10341 return false; // Could not determine image type
10343 return DoMakeImageBlock(image
, imageType
);
10346 // Uses a const wxImage for efficiency, but can't set quality (only relevant for JPEG)
10347 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::MakeImageBlockDefaultQuality(const wxImage
& image
, wxBitmapType imageType
)
10349 if (imageType
== wxBITMAP_TYPE_INVALID
)
10350 return false; // Could not determine image type
10352 return DoMakeImageBlock(image
, imageType
);
10355 // Makes the image block
10356 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::DoMakeImageBlock(const wxImage
& image
, wxBitmapType imageType
)
10358 wxMemoryOutputStream memStream
;
10359 if (!image
.SaveFile(memStream
, imageType
))
10364 unsigned char* block
= new unsigned char[memStream
.GetSize()];
10372 m_imageType
= imageType
;
10373 m_dataSize
= memStream
.GetSize();
10375 memStream
.CopyTo(m_data
, m_dataSize
);
10377 return (m_data
!= NULL
);
10381 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::Write(const wxString
& filename
)
10383 return WriteBlock(filename
, m_data
, m_dataSize
);
10386 void wxRichTextImageBlock::Copy(const wxRichTextImageBlock
& block
)
10388 m_imageType
= block
.m_imageType
;
10390 m_dataSize
= block
.m_dataSize
;
10391 if (m_dataSize
== 0)
10394 m_data
= new unsigned char[m_dataSize
];
10396 for (i
= 0; i
< m_dataSize
; i
++)
10397 m_data
[i
] = block
.m_data
[i
];
10401 void wxRichTextImageBlock::operator=(const wxRichTextImageBlock
& block
)
10406 // Load a wxImage from the block
10407 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::Load(wxImage
& image
)
10412 // Read in the image.
10414 wxMemoryInputStream
mstream(m_data
, m_dataSize
);
10415 bool success
= image
.LoadFile(mstream
, GetImageType());
10417 wxString tempFile
= wxFileName::CreateTempFileName(_("image"));
10418 wxASSERT(!tempFile
.IsEmpty());
10420 if (!WriteBlock(tempFile
, m_data
, m_dataSize
))
10424 success
= image
.LoadFile(tempFile
, GetImageType());
10425 wxRemoveFile(tempFile
);
10431 // Write data in hex to a stream
10432 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::WriteHex(wxOutputStream
& stream
)
10434 if (m_dataSize
== 0)
10437 int bufSize
= 100000;
10438 if (int(2*m_dataSize
) < bufSize
)
10439 bufSize
= 2*m_dataSize
;
10440 char* buf
= new char[bufSize
+1];
10442 int left
= m_dataSize
;
10447 if (left
*2 > bufSize
)
10449 n
= bufSize
; left
-= (bufSize
/2);
10453 n
= left
*2; left
= 0;
10457 for (i
= 0; i
< (n
/2); i
++)
10459 wxDecToHex(m_data
[j
], b
, b
+1);
10464 stream
.Write((const char*) buf
, n
);
10470 // Read data in hex from a stream
10471 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::ReadHex(wxInputStream
& stream
, int length
, wxBitmapType imageType
)
10473 int dataSize
= length
/2;
10478 // create a null terminated temporary string:
10482 m_data
= new unsigned char[dataSize
];
10484 for (i
= 0; i
< dataSize
; i
++)
10486 str
[0] = (char)stream
.GetC();
10487 str
[1] = (char)stream
.GetC();
10489 m_data
[i
] = (unsigned char)wxHexToDec(str
);
10492 m_dataSize
= dataSize
;
10493 m_imageType
= imageType
;
10498 // Allocate and read from stream as a block of memory
10499 unsigned char* wxRichTextImageBlock::ReadBlock(wxInputStream
& stream
, size_t size
)
10501 unsigned char* block
= new unsigned char[size
];
10505 stream
.Read(block
, size
);
10510 unsigned char* wxRichTextImageBlock::ReadBlock(const wxString
& filename
, size_t size
)
10512 wxFileInputStream
stream(filename
);
10513 if (!stream
.IsOk())
10516 return ReadBlock(stream
, size
);
10519 // Write memory block to stream
10520 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::WriteBlock(wxOutputStream
& stream
, unsigned char* block
, size_t size
)
10522 stream
.Write((void*) block
, size
);
10523 return stream
.IsOk();
10527 // Write memory block to file
10528 bool wxRichTextImageBlock::WriteBlock(const wxString
& filename
, unsigned char* block
, size_t size
)
10530 wxFileOutputStream
outStream(filename
);
10531 if (!outStream
.IsOk())
10534 return WriteBlock(outStream
, block
, size
);
10537 // Gets the extension for the block's type
10538 wxString
wxRichTextImageBlock::GetExtension() const
10540 wxImageHandler
* handler
= wxImage::FindHandler(GetImageType());
10542 return handler
->GetExtension();
10544 return wxEmptyString
;
10550 * The data object for a wxRichTextBuffer
10553 const wxChar
*wxRichTextBufferDataObject::ms_richTextBufferFormatId
= wxT("wxShape");
10555 wxRichTextBufferDataObject::wxRichTextBufferDataObject(wxRichTextBuffer
* richTextBuffer
)
10557 m_richTextBuffer
= richTextBuffer
;
10559 // this string should uniquely identify our format, but is otherwise
10561 m_formatRichTextBuffer
.SetId(GetRichTextBufferFormatId());
10563 SetFormat(m_formatRichTextBuffer
);
10566 wxRichTextBufferDataObject::~wxRichTextBufferDataObject()
10568 delete m_richTextBuffer
;
10571 // after a call to this function, the richTextBuffer is owned by the caller and it
10572 // is responsible for deleting it!
10573 wxRichTextBuffer
* wxRichTextBufferDataObject::GetRichTextBuffer()
10575 wxRichTextBuffer
* richTextBuffer
= m_richTextBuffer
;
10576 m_richTextBuffer
= NULL
;
10578 return richTextBuffer
;
10581 wxDataFormat
wxRichTextBufferDataObject::GetPreferredFormat(Direction
WXUNUSED(dir
)) const
10583 return m_formatRichTextBuffer
;
10586 size_t wxRichTextBufferDataObject::GetDataSize() const
10588 if (!m_richTextBuffer
)
10594 wxStringOutputStream
stream(& bufXML
);
10595 if (!m_richTextBuffer
->SaveFile(stream
, wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_XML
))
10597 wxLogError(wxT("Could not write the buffer to an XML stream.\nYou may have forgotten to add the XML file handler."));
10603 wxCharBuffer buffer
= bufXML
.mb_str(wxConvUTF8
);
10604 return strlen(buffer
) + 1;
10606 return bufXML
.Length()+1;
10610 bool wxRichTextBufferDataObject::GetDataHere(void *pBuf
) const
10612 if (!pBuf
|| !m_richTextBuffer
)
10618 wxStringOutputStream
stream(& bufXML
);
10619 if (!m_richTextBuffer
->SaveFile(stream
, wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_XML
))
10621 wxLogError(wxT("Could not write the buffer to an XML stream.\nYou may have forgotten to add the XML file handler."));
10627 wxCharBuffer buffer
= bufXML
.mb_str(wxConvUTF8
);
10628 size_t len
= strlen(buffer
);
10629 memcpy((char*) pBuf
, (const char*) buffer
, len
);
10630 ((char*) pBuf
)[len
] = 0;
10632 size_t len
= bufXML
.Length();
10633 memcpy((char*) pBuf
, (const char*) bufXML
.c_str(), len
);
10634 ((char*) pBuf
)[len
] = 0;
10640 bool wxRichTextBufferDataObject::SetData(size_t WXUNUSED(len
), const void *buf
)
10642 wxDELETE(m_richTextBuffer
);
10644 wxString
bufXML((const char*) buf
, wxConvUTF8
);
10646 m_richTextBuffer
= new wxRichTextBuffer
;
10648 wxStringInputStream
stream(bufXML
);
10649 if (!m_richTextBuffer
->LoadFile(stream
, wxRICHTEXT_TYPE_XML
))
10651 wxLogError(wxT("Could not read the buffer from an XML stream.\nYou may have forgotten to add the XML file handler."));
10653 wxDELETE(m_richTextBuffer
);
10665 * wxRichTextFontTable
10666 * Manages quick access to a pool of fonts for rendering rich text
10669 WX_DECLARE_STRING_HASH_MAP_WITH_DECL(wxFont
, wxRichTextFontTableHashMap
, class WXDLLIMPEXP_RICHTEXT
);
10671 class wxRichTextFontTableData
: public wxObjectRefData
10674 wxRichTextFontTableData() {}
10676 wxFont
FindFont(const wxRichTextAttr
& fontSpec
);
10678 wxRichTextFontTableHashMap m_hashMap
;
10681 wxFont
wxRichTextFontTableData::FindFont(const wxRichTextAttr
& fontSpec
)
10683 wxString
facename(fontSpec
.GetFontFaceName());
10684 wxString
spec(wxString::Format(wxT("%d-%d-%d-%d-%s-%d"), fontSpec
.GetFontSize(), fontSpec
.GetFontStyle(), fontSpec
.GetFontWeight(), (int) fontSpec
.GetFontUnderlined(), facename
.c_str(), (int) fontSpec
.GetFontEncoding()));
10685 wxRichTextFontTableHashMap::iterator entry
= m_hashMap
.find(spec
);
10687 if ( entry
== m_hashMap
.end() )
10689 wxFont
font(fontSpec
.GetFontSize(), wxDEFAULT
, fontSpec
.GetFontStyle(), fontSpec
.GetFontWeight(), fontSpec
.GetFontUnderlined(), facename
.c_str());
10690 m_hashMap
[spec
] = font
;
10695 return entry
->second
;
10699 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextFontTable
, wxObject
)
10701 wxRichTextFontTable::wxRichTextFontTable()
10703 m_refData
= new wxRichTextFontTableData
;
10706 wxRichTextFontTable::wxRichTextFontTable(const wxRichTextFontTable
& table
)
10712 wxRichTextFontTable::~wxRichTextFontTable()
10717 bool wxRichTextFontTable::operator == (const wxRichTextFontTable
& table
) const
10719 return (m_refData
== table
.m_refData
);
10722 void wxRichTextFontTable::operator= (const wxRichTextFontTable
& table
)
10727 wxFont
wxRichTextFontTable::FindFont(const wxRichTextAttr
& fontSpec
)
10729 wxRichTextFontTableData
* data
= (wxRichTextFontTableData
*) m_refData
;
10731 return data
->FindFont(fontSpec
);
10736 void wxRichTextFontTable::Clear()
10738 wxRichTextFontTableData
* data
= (wxRichTextFontTableData
*) m_refData
;
10740 data
->m_hashMap
.clear();
10746 void wxTextBoxAttr::Reset()
10749 m_floatMode
= wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT_NONE
;
10750 m_clearMode
= wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_CLEAR_NONE
;
10751 m_collapseMode
= wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_COLLAPSE_NONE
;
10752 m_verticalAlignment
= wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_NONE
;
10756 m_position
.Reset();
10765 bool wxTextBoxAttr::operator== (const wxTextBoxAttr
& attr
) const
10768 m_flags
== attr
.m_flags
&&
10769 m_floatMode
== attr
.m_floatMode
&&
10770 m_clearMode
== attr
.m_clearMode
&&
10771 m_collapseMode
== attr
.m_collapseMode
&&
10772 m_verticalAlignment
== attr
.m_verticalAlignment
&&
10774 m_margins
== attr
.m_margins
&&
10775 m_padding
== attr
.m_padding
&&
10776 m_position
== attr
.m_position
&&
10778 m_size
== attr
.m_size
&&
10780 m_border
== attr
.m_border
&&
10781 m_outline
== attr
.m_outline
10785 // Partial equality test
10786 bool wxTextBoxAttr::EqPartial(const wxTextBoxAttr
& attr
) const
10788 if (attr
.HasFloatMode() && HasFloatMode() && (GetFloatMode() != attr
.GetFloatMode()))
10791 if (attr
.HasClearMode() && HasClearMode() && (GetClearMode() != attr
.GetClearMode()))
10794 if (attr
.HasCollapseBorders() && HasCollapseBorders() && (attr
.GetCollapseBorders() != GetCollapseBorders()))
10797 if (attr
.HasVerticalAlignment() && HasVerticalAlignment() && (attr
.GetVerticalAlignment() != GetVerticalAlignment()))
10802 if (!m_position
.EqPartial(attr
.m_position
))
10807 if (!m_margins
.EqPartial(attr
.m_margins
))
10812 if (!m_padding
.EqPartial(attr
.m_padding
))
10817 if (!GetBorder().EqPartial(attr
.GetBorder()))
10822 if (!GetOutline().EqPartial(attr
.GetOutline()))
10828 // Merges the given attributes. If compareWith
10829 // is non-NULL, then it will be used to mask out those attributes that are the same in style
10830 // and compareWith, for situations where we don't want to explicitly set inherited attributes.
10831 bool wxTextBoxAttr::Apply(const wxTextBoxAttr
& attr
, const wxTextBoxAttr
* compareWith
)
10833 if (attr
.HasFloatMode())
10835 if (!(compareWith
&& compareWith
->HasFloatMode() && compareWith
->GetFloatMode() == attr
.GetFloatMode()))
10836 SetFloatMode(attr
.GetFloatMode());
10839 if (attr
.HasClearMode())
10841 if (!(compareWith
&& compareWith
->HasClearMode() && compareWith
->GetClearMode() == attr
.GetClearMode()))
10842 SetClearMode(attr
.GetClearMode());
10845 if (attr
.HasCollapseBorders())
10847 if (!(compareWith
&& compareWith
->HasCollapseBorders() && compareWith
->GetCollapseBorders() == attr
.GetCollapseBorders()))
10848 SetCollapseBorders(attr
.GetCollapseBorders());
10851 if (attr
.HasVerticalAlignment())
10853 if (!(compareWith
&& compareWith
->HasVerticalAlignment() && compareWith
->GetVerticalAlignment() == attr
.GetVerticalAlignment()))
10854 SetVerticalAlignment(attr
.GetVerticalAlignment());
10857 m_margins
.Apply(attr
.m_margins
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_margins
) : (const wxTextAttrDimensions
*) NULL
);
10858 m_padding
.Apply(attr
.m_padding
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_padding
) : (const wxTextAttrDimensions
*) NULL
);
10859 m_position
.Apply(attr
.m_position
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_position
) : (const wxTextAttrDimensions
*) NULL
);
10861 m_size
.Apply(attr
.m_size
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_size
) : (const wxTextAttrSize
*) NULL
);
10863 m_border
.Apply(attr
.m_border
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_border
) : (const wxTextAttrBorders
*) NULL
);
10864 m_outline
.Apply(attr
.m_outline
, compareWith
? (& attr
.m_outline
) : (const wxTextAttrBorders
*) NULL
);
10869 // Remove specified attributes from this object
10870 bool wxTextBoxAttr::RemoveStyle(const wxTextBoxAttr
& attr
)
10872 if (attr
.HasFloatMode())
10873 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT
);
10875 if (attr
.HasClearMode())
10876 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_CLEAR
);
10878 if (attr
.HasCollapseBorders())
10879 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_COLLAPSE_BORDERS
);
10881 if (attr
.HasVerticalAlignment())
10882 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT
);
10884 m_margins
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_margins
);
10885 m_padding
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_padding
);
10886 m_position
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_position
);
10888 m_size
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_size
);
10890 m_border
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_border
);
10891 m_outline
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_outline
);
10896 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
10897 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
10898 void wxTextBoxAttr::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxTextBoxAttr
& attr
, wxTextBoxAttr
& clashingAttr
, wxTextBoxAttr
& absentAttr
)
10900 if (attr
.HasFloatMode())
10902 if (!clashingAttr
.HasFloatMode() && !absentAttr
.HasFloatMode())
10904 if (HasFloatMode())
10906 if (GetFloatMode() != attr
.GetFloatMode())
10908 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT
);
10909 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT
);
10913 SetFloatMode(attr
.GetFloatMode());
10917 absentAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_FLOAT
);
10919 if (attr
.HasClearMode())
10921 if (!clashingAttr
.HasClearMode() && !absentAttr
.HasClearMode())
10923 if (HasClearMode())
10925 if (GetClearMode() != attr
.GetClearMode())
10927 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_CLEAR
);
10928 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_CLEAR
);
10932 SetClearMode(attr
.GetClearMode());
10936 absentAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_CLEAR
);
10938 if (attr
.HasCollapseBorders())
10940 if (!clashingAttr
.HasCollapseBorders() && !absentAttr
.HasCollapseBorders())
10942 if (HasCollapseBorders())
10944 if (GetCollapseBorders() != attr
.GetCollapseBorders())
10946 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_COLLAPSE_BORDERS
);
10947 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_COLLAPSE_BORDERS
);
10951 SetCollapseBorders(attr
.GetCollapseBorders());
10955 absentAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_COLLAPSE_BORDERS
);
10957 if (attr
.HasVerticalAlignment())
10959 if (!clashingAttr
.HasVerticalAlignment() && !absentAttr
.HasVerticalAlignment())
10961 if (HasVerticalAlignment())
10963 if (GetVerticalAlignment() != attr
.GetVerticalAlignment())
10965 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT
);
10966 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT
);
10970 SetVerticalAlignment(attr
.GetVerticalAlignment());
10974 absentAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT
);
10976 m_margins
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_margins
, clashingAttr
.m_margins
, absentAttr
.m_margins
);
10977 m_padding
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_padding
, clashingAttr
.m_padding
, absentAttr
.m_padding
);
10978 m_position
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_position
, clashingAttr
.m_position
, absentAttr
.m_position
);
10980 m_size
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_size
, clashingAttr
.m_size
, absentAttr
.m_size
);
10982 m_border
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_border
, clashingAttr
.m_border
, absentAttr
.m_border
);
10983 m_outline
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_outline
, clashingAttr
.m_outline
, absentAttr
.m_outline
);
10988 void wxRichTextAttr::Copy(const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
)
10990 wxTextAttr::Copy(attr
);
10992 m_textBoxAttr
= attr
.m_textBoxAttr
;
10995 bool wxRichTextAttr::operator==(const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
) const
10997 if (!(wxTextAttr::operator==(attr
)))
11000 return (m_textBoxAttr
== attr
.m_textBoxAttr
);
11003 // Partial equality test taking comparison object into account
11004 bool wxRichTextAttr::EqPartial(const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
) const
11006 if (!(wxTextAttr::EqPartial(attr
)))
11009 return m_textBoxAttr
.EqPartial(attr
.m_textBoxAttr
);
11012 // Merges the given attributes. If compareWith
11013 // is non-NULL, then it will be used to mask out those attributes that are the same in style
11014 // and compareWith, for situations where we don't want to explicitly set inherited attributes.
11015 bool wxRichTextAttr::Apply(const wxRichTextAttr
& style
, const wxRichTextAttr
* compareWith
)
11017 wxTextAttr::Apply(style
, compareWith
);
11019 return m_textBoxAttr
.Apply(style
.m_textBoxAttr
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_textBoxAttr
) : (const wxTextBoxAttr
*) NULL
);
11022 // Remove specified attributes from this object
11023 bool wxRichTextAttr::RemoveStyle(const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
)
11025 wxTextAttr::RemoveStyle(*this, attr
);
11027 return m_textBoxAttr
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_textBoxAttr
);
11030 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
11031 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
11032 void wxRichTextAttr::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxRichTextAttr
& attr
, wxRichTextAttr
& clashingAttr
, wxRichTextAttr
& absentAttr
)
11034 wxTextAttrCollectCommonAttributes(*this, attr
, clashingAttr
, absentAttr
);
11036 m_textBoxAttr
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_textBoxAttr
, clashingAttr
.m_textBoxAttr
, absentAttr
.m_textBoxAttr
);
11039 // Partial equality test
11040 bool wxTextAttrBorder::EqPartial(const wxTextAttrBorder
& border
) const
11042 if (border
.HasStyle() && !HasStyle() && (border
.GetStyle() != GetStyle()))
11045 if (border
.HasColour() && !HasColour() && (border
.GetColourLong() != GetColourLong()))
11048 if (border
.HasWidth() && !HasWidth() && !(border
.GetWidth() == GetWidth()))
11054 // Apply border to 'this', but not if the same as compareWith
11055 bool wxTextAttrBorder::Apply(const wxTextAttrBorder
& border
, const wxTextAttrBorder
* compareWith
)
11057 if (border
.HasStyle())
11059 if (!(compareWith
&& (border
.GetStyle() == compareWith
->GetStyle())))
11060 SetStyle(border
.GetStyle());
11062 if (border
.HasColour())
11064 if (!(compareWith
&& (border
.GetColourLong() == compareWith
->GetColourLong())))
11065 SetColour(border
.GetColourLong());
11067 if (border
.HasWidth())
11069 if (!(compareWith
&& (border
.GetWidth() == compareWith
->GetWidth())))
11070 SetWidth(border
.GetWidth());
11076 // Remove specified attributes from this object
11077 bool wxTextAttrBorder::RemoveStyle(const wxTextAttrBorder
& attr
)
11079 if (attr
.HasStyle() && HasStyle())
11080 SetFlags(GetFlags() & ~wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_STYLE
);
11081 if (attr
.HasColour() && HasColour())
11082 SetFlags(GetFlags() & ~wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_COLOUR
);
11083 if (attr
.HasWidth() && HasWidth())
11084 m_borderWidth
.Reset();
11089 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
11090 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
11091 void wxTextAttrBorder::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxTextAttrBorder
& attr
, wxTextAttrBorder
& clashingAttr
, wxTextAttrBorder
& absentAttr
)
11093 if (attr
.HasStyle())
11095 if (!clashingAttr
.HasStyle() && !absentAttr
.HasStyle())
11099 if (GetStyle() != attr
.GetStyle())
11101 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_STYLE
);
11102 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_STYLE
);
11106 SetStyle(attr
.GetStyle());
11110 absentAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_STYLE
);
11112 if (attr
.HasColour())
11114 if (!clashingAttr
.HasColour() && !absentAttr
.HasColour())
11118 if (GetColour() != attr
.GetColour())
11120 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_COLOUR
);
11121 RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_COLOUR
);
11125 SetColour(attr
.GetColourLong());
11129 absentAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_BOX_ATTR_BORDER_COLOUR
);
11131 m_borderWidth
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_borderWidth
, clashingAttr
.m_borderWidth
, absentAttr
.m_borderWidth
);
11134 // Partial equality test
11135 bool wxTextAttrBorders::EqPartial(const wxTextAttrBorders
& borders
) const
11137 return m_left
.EqPartial(borders
.m_left
) && m_right
.EqPartial(borders
.m_right
) &&
11138 m_top
.EqPartial(borders
.m_top
) && m_bottom
.EqPartial(borders
.m_bottom
);
11141 // Apply border to 'this', but not if the same as compareWith
11142 bool wxTextAttrBorders::Apply(const wxTextAttrBorders
& borders
, const wxTextAttrBorders
* compareWith
)
11144 m_left
.Apply(borders
.m_left
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_left
) : (const wxTextAttrBorder
*) NULL
);
11145 m_right
.Apply(borders
.m_right
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_right
) : (const wxTextAttrBorder
*) NULL
);
11146 m_top
.Apply(borders
.m_top
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_top
) : (const wxTextAttrBorder
*) NULL
);
11147 m_bottom
.Apply(borders
.m_bottom
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_bottom
) : (const wxTextAttrBorder
*) NULL
);
11151 // Remove specified attributes from this object
11152 bool wxTextAttrBorders::RemoveStyle(const wxTextAttrBorders
& attr
)
11154 m_left
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_left
);
11155 m_right
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_right
);
11156 m_top
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_top
);
11157 m_bottom
.RemoveStyle(attr
.m_bottom
);
11161 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
11162 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
11163 void wxTextAttrBorders::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxTextAttrBorders
& attr
, wxTextAttrBorders
& clashingAttr
, wxTextAttrBorders
& absentAttr
)
11165 m_left
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_left
, clashingAttr
.m_left
, absentAttr
.m_left
);
11166 m_right
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_right
, clashingAttr
.m_right
, absentAttr
.m_right
);
11167 m_top
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_top
, clashingAttr
.m_top
, absentAttr
.m_top
);
11168 m_bottom
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_bottom
, clashingAttr
.m_bottom
, absentAttr
.m_bottom
);
11171 // Set style of all borders
11172 void wxTextAttrBorders::SetStyle(int style
)
11174 m_left
.SetStyle(style
);
11175 m_right
.SetStyle(style
);
11176 m_top
.SetStyle(style
);
11177 m_bottom
.SetStyle(style
);
11180 // Set colour of all borders
11181 void wxTextAttrBorders::SetColour(unsigned long colour
)
11183 m_left
.SetColour(colour
);
11184 m_right
.SetColour(colour
);
11185 m_top
.SetColour(colour
);
11186 m_bottom
.SetColour(colour
);
11189 void wxTextAttrBorders::SetColour(const wxColour
& colour
)
11191 m_left
.SetColour(colour
);
11192 m_right
.SetColour(colour
);
11193 m_top
.SetColour(colour
);
11194 m_bottom
.SetColour(colour
);
11197 // Set width of all borders
11198 void wxTextAttrBorders::SetWidth(const wxTextAttrDimension
& width
)
11200 m_left
.SetWidth(width
);
11201 m_right
.SetWidth(width
);
11202 m_top
.SetWidth(width
);
11203 m_bottom
.SetWidth(width
);
11206 // Partial equality test
11207 bool wxTextAttrDimension::EqPartial(const wxTextAttrDimension
& dim
) const
11209 if (dim
.IsValid() && IsValid() && !((*this) == dim
))
11215 bool wxTextAttrDimension::Apply(const wxTextAttrDimension
& dim
, const wxTextAttrDimension
* compareWith
)
11219 if (!(compareWith
&& dim
== (*compareWith
)))
11226 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
11227 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
11228 void wxTextAttrDimension::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxTextAttrDimension
& attr
, wxTextAttrDimension
& clashingAttr
, wxTextAttrDimension
& absentAttr
)
11230 if (attr
.IsValid())
11232 if (!clashingAttr
.IsValid() && !absentAttr
.IsValid())
11236 if (!((*this) == attr
))
11238 clashingAttr
.SetValid(true);
11247 absentAttr
.SetValid(true);
11250 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter::wxTextAttrDimensionConverter(wxDC
& dc
, double scale
, const wxSize
& parentSize
)
11252 m_ppi
= dc
.GetPPI().x
; m_scale
= scale
; m_parentSize
= parentSize
;
11255 wxTextAttrDimensionConverter::wxTextAttrDimensionConverter(int ppi
, double scale
, const wxSize
& parentSize
)
11257 m_ppi
= ppi
; m_scale
= scale
; m_parentSize
= parentSize
;
11260 int wxTextAttrDimensionConverter::ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(int units
) const
11262 return wxRichTextObject::ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(m_ppi
, units
, m_scale
);
11265 int wxTextAttrDimensionConverter::ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(int pixels
) const
11267 return wxRichTextObject::ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(m_ppi
, pixels
, m_scale
);
11270 int wxTextAttrDimensionConverter::GetPixels(const wxTextAttrDimension
& dim
, int direction
) const
11272 if (dim
.GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
11273 return ConvertTenthsMMToPixels(dim
.GetValue());
11274 else if (dim
.GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
)
11275 return dim
.GetValue();
11276 else if (dim
.GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PERCENTAGE
)
11278 wxASSERT(m_parentSize
!= wxDefaultSize
);
11279 if (direction
== wxHORIZONTAL
)
11280 return (int) (double(m_parentSize
.x
) * double(dim
.GetValue()) / 100.0);
11282 return (int) (double(m_parentSize
.y
) * double(dim
.GetValue()) / 100.0);
11291 int wxTextAttrDimensionConverter::GetTenthsMM(const wxTextAttrDimension
& dim
) const
11293 if (dim
.GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_TENTHS_MM
)
11294 return dim
.GetValue();
11295 else if (dim
.GetUnits() == wxTEXT_ATTR_UNITS_PIXELS
)
11296 return ConvertPixelsToTenthsMM(dim
.GetValue());
11304 // Partial equality test
11305 bool wxTextAttrDimensions::EqPartial(const wxTextAttrDimensions
& dims
) const
11307 if (!m_left
.EqPartial(dims
.m_left
))
11310 if (!m_right
.EqPartial(dims
.m_right
))
11313 if (!m_top
.EqPartial(dims
.m_top
))
11316 if (!m_bottom
.EqPartial(dims
.m_bottom
))
11322 // Apply border to 'this', but not if the same as compareWith
11323 bool wxTextAttrDimensions::Apply(const wxTextAttrDimensions
& dims
, const wxTextAttrDimensions
* compareWith
)
11325 m_left
.Apply(dims
.m_left
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_left
) : (const wxTextAttrDimension
*) NULL
);
11326 m_right
.Apply(dims
.m_right
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_right
): (const wxTextAttrDimension
*) NULL
);
11327 m_top
.Apply(dims
.m_top
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_top
): (const wxTextAttrDimension
*) NULL
);
11328 m_bottom
.Apply(dims
.m_bottom
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_bottom
): (const wxTextAttrDimension
*) NULL
);
11333 // Remove specified attributes from this object
11334 bool wxTextAttrDimensions::RemoveStyle(const wxTextAttrDimensions
& attr
)
11336 if (attr
.m_left
.IsValid())
11338 if (attr
.m_right
.IsValid())
11340 if (attr
.m_top
.IsValid())
11342 if (attr
.m_bottom
.IsValid())
11348 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
11349 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
11350 void wxTextAttrDimensions::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxTextAttrDimensions
& attr
, wxTextAttrDimensions
& clashingAttr
, wxTextAttrDimensions
& absentAttr
)
11352 m_left
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_left
, clashingAttr
.m_left
, absentAttr
.m_left
);
11353 m_right
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_right
, clashingAttr
.m_right
, absentAttr
.m_right
);
11354 m_top
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_top
, clashingAttr
.m_top
, absentAttr
.m_top
);
11355 m_bottom
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_bottom
, clashingAttr
.m_bottom
, absentAttr
.m_bottom
);
11358 // Partial equality test
11359 bool wxTextAttrSize::EqPartial(const wxTextAttrSize
& size
) const
11361 if (!m_width
.EqPartial(size
.m_width
))
11364 if (!m_height
.EqPartial(size
.m_height
))
11370 // Apply border to 'this', but not if the same as compareWith
11371 bool wxTextAttrSize::Apply(const wxTextAttrSize
& size
, const wxTextAttrSize
* compareWith
)
11373 m_width
.Apply(size
.m_width
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_width
) : (const wxTextAttrDimension
*) NULL
);
11374 m_height
.Apply(size
.m_height
, compareWith
? (& compareWith
->m_height
): (const wxTextAttrDimension
*) NULL
);
11379 // Remove specified attributes from this object
11380 bool wxTextAttrSize::RemoveStyle(const wxTextAttrSize
& attr
)
11382 if (attr
.m_width
.IsValid())
11384 if (attr
.m_height
.IsValid())
11390 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
11391 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
11392 void wxTextAttrSize::CollectCommonAttributes(const wxTextAttrSize
& attr
, wxTextAttrSize
& clashingAttr
, wxTextAttrSize
& absentAttr
)
11394 m_width
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_width
, clashingAttr
.m_width
, absentAttr
.m_width
);
11395 m_height
.CollectCommonAttributes(attr
.m_height
, clashingAttr
.m_height
, absentAttr
.m_height
);
11398 // Collects the attributes that are common to a range of content, building up a note of
11399 // which attributes are absent in some objects and which clash in some objects.
11400 void wxTextAttrCollectCommonAttributes(wxTextAttr
& currentStyle
, const wxTextAttr
& attr
, wxTextAttr
& clashingAttr
, wxTextAttr
& absentAttr
)
11402 absentAttr
.SetFlags(absentAttr
.GetFlags() | (~attr
.GetFlags() & wxTEXT_ATTR_ALL
));
11403 absentAttr
.SetTextEffectFlags(absentAttr
.GetTextEffectFlags() | (~attr
.GetTextEffectFlags() & 0xFFFF));
11405 long forbiddenFlags
= clashingAttr
.GetFlags()|absentAttr
.GetFlags();
11407 if (attr
.HasFont())
11409 if (attr
.HasFontSize() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_SIZE
))
11411 if (currentStyle
.HasFontSize())
11413 if (currentStyle
.GetFontSize() != attr
.GetFontSize())
11415 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11416 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_SIZE
);
11417 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_SIZE
);
11421 currentStyle
.SetFontSize(attr
.GetFontSize());
11424 if (attr
.HasFontItalic() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_ITALIC
))
11426 if (currentStyle
.HasFontItalic())
11428 if (currentStyle
.GetFontStyle() != attr
.GetFontStyle())
11430 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11431 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_ITALIC
);
11432 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_ITALIC
);
11436 currentStyle
.SetFontStyle(attr
.GetFontStyle());
11439 if (attr
.HasFontFamily() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FAMILY
))
11441 if (currentStyle
.HasFontFamily())
11443 if (currentStyle
.GetFontFamily() != attr
.GetFontFamily())
11445 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11446 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FAMILY
);
11447 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FAMILY
);
11451 currentStyle
.SetFontFamily(attr
.GetFontFamily());
11454 if (attr
.HasFontWeight() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_WEIGHT
))
11456 if (currentStyle
.HasFontWeight())
11458 if (currentStyle
.GetFontWeight() != attr
.GetFontWeight())
11460 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11461 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_WEIGHT
);
11462 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_WEIGHT
);
11466 currentStyle
.SetFontWeight(attr
.GetFontWeight());
11469 if (attr
.HasFontFaceName() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FACE
))
11471 if (currentStyle
.HasFontFaceName())
11473 wxString
faceName1(currentStyle
.GetFontFaceName());
11474 wxString
faceName2(attr
.GetFontFaceName());
11476 if (faceName1
!= faceName2
)
11478 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11479 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FACE
);
11480 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_FACE
);
11484 currentStyle
.SetFontFaceName(attr
.GetFontFaceName());
11487 if (attr
.HasFontUnderlined() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_UNDERLINE
))
11489 if (currentStyle
.HasFontUnderlined())
11491 if (currentStyle
.GetFontUnderlined() != attr
.GetFontUnderlined())
11493 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11494 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_UNDERLINE
);
11495 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_FONT_UNDERLINE
);
11499 currentStyle
.SetFontUnderlined(attr
.GetFontUnderlined());
11503 if (attr
.HasTextColour() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_TEXT_COLOUR
))
11505 if (currentStyle
.HasTextColour())
11507 if (currentStyle
.GetTextColour() != attr
.GetTextColour())
11509 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11510 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_TEXT_COLOUR
);
11511 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_TEXT_COLOUR
);
11515 currentStyle
.SetTextColour(attr
.GetTextColour());
11518 if (attr
.HasBackgroundColour() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
))
11520 if (currentStyle
.HasBackgroundColour())
11522 if (currentStyle
.GetBackgroundColour() != attr
.GetBackgroundColour())
11524 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11525 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
);
11526 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BACKGROUND_COLOUR
);
11530 currentStyle
.SetBackgroundColour(attr
.GetBackgroundColour());
11533 if (attr
.HasAlignment() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_ALIGNMENT
))
11535 if (currentStyle
.HasAlignment())
11537 if (currentStyle
.GetAlignment() != attr
.GetAlignment())
11539 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11540 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_ALIGNMENT
);
11541 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_ALIGNMENT
);
11545 currentStyle
.SetAlignment(attr
.GetAlignment());
11548 if (attr
.HasTabs() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_TABS
))
11550 if (currentStyle
.HasTabs())
11552 if (!wxRichTextTabsEq(currentStyle
.GetTabs(), attr
.GetTabs()))
11554 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11555 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_TABS
);
11556 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_TABS
);
11560 currentStyle
.SetTabs(attr
.GetTabs());
11563 if (attr
.HasLeftIndent() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
))
11565 if (currentStyle
.HasLeftIndent())
11567 if (currentStyle
.GetLeftIndent() != attr
.GetLeftIndent() || currentStyle
.GetLeftSubIndent() != attr
.GetLeftSubIndent())
11569 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11570 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
11571 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LEFT_INDENT
);
11575 currentStyle
.SetLeftIndent(attr
.GetLeftIndent(), attr
.GetLeftSubIndent());
11578 if (attr
.HasRightIndent() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_RIGHT_INDENT
))
11580 if (currentStyle
.HasRightIndent())
11582 if (currentStyle
.GetRightIndent() != attr
.GetRightIndent())
11584 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11585 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_RIGHT_INDENT
);
11586 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_RIGHT_INDENT
);
11590 currentStyle
.SetRightIndent(attr
.GetRightIndent());
11593 if (attr
.HasParagraphSpacingAfter() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_AFTER
))
11595 if (currentStyle
.HasParagraphSpacingAfter())
11597 if (currentStyle
.GetParagraphSpacingAfter() != attr
.GetParagraphSpacingAfter())
11599 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11600 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_AFTER
);
11601 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_AFTER
);
11605 currentStyle
.SetParagraphSpacingAfter(attr
.GetParagraphSpacingAfter());
11608 if (attr
.HasParagraphSpacingBefore() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_BEFORE
))
11610 if (currentStyle
.HasParagraphSpacingBefore())
11612 if (currentStyle
.GetParagraphSpacingBefore() != attr
.GetParagraphSpacingBefore())
11614 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11615 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_BEFORE
);
11616 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARA_SPACING_BEFORE
);
11620 currentStyle
.SetParagraphSpacingBefore(attr
.GetParagraphSpacingBefore());
11623 if (attr
.HasLineSpacing() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_LINE_SPACING
))
11625 if (currentStyle
.HasLineSpacing())
11627 if (currentStyle
.GetLineSpacing() != attr
.GetLineSpacing())
11629 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11630 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LINE_SPACING
);
11631 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LINE_SPACING
);
11635 currentStyle
.SetLineSpacing(attr
.GetLineSpacing());
11638 if (attr
.HasCharacterStyleName() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_CHARACTER_STYLE_NAME
))
11640 if (currentStyle
.HasCharacterStyleName())
11642 if (currentStyle
.GetCharacterStyleName() != attr
.GetCharacterStyleName())
11644 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11645 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_CHARACTER_STYLE_NAME
);
11646 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_CHARACTER_STYLE_NAME
);
11650 currentStyle
.SetCharacterStyleName(attr
.GetCharacterStyleName());
11653 if (attr
.HasParagraphStyleName() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_PARAGRAPH_STYLE_NAME
))
11655 if (currentStyle
.HasParagraphStyleName())
11657 if (currentStyle
.GetParagraphStyleName() != attr
.GetParagraphStyleName())
11659 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11660 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARAGRAPH_STYLE_NAME
);
11661 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_PARAGRAPH_STYLE_NAME
);
11665 currentStyle
.SetParagraphStyleName(attr
.GetParagraphStyleName());
11668 if (attr
.HasListStyleName() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_LIST_STYLE_NAME
))
11670 if (currentStyle
.HasListStyleName())
11672 if (currentStyle
.GetListStyleName() != attr
.GetListStyleName())
11674 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11675 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LIST_STYLE_NAME
);
11676 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_LIST_STYLE_NAME
);
11680 currentStyle
.SetListStyleName(attr
.GetListStyleName());
11683 if (attr
.HasBulletStyle() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
))
11685 if (currentStyle
.HasBulletStyle())
11687 if (currentStyle
.GetBulletStyle() != attr
.GetBulletStyle())
11689 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11690 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
);
11691 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_STYLE
);
11695 currentStyle
.SetBulletStyle(attr
.GetBulletStyle());
11698 if (attr
.HasBulletNumber() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NUMBER
))
11700 if (currentStyle
.HasBulletNumber())
11702 if (currentStyle
.GetBulletNumber() != attr
.GetBulletNumber())
11704 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11705 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NUMBER
);
11706 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NUMBER
);
11710 currentStyle
.SetBulletNumber(attr
.GetBulletNumber());
11713 if (attr
.HasBulletText() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_TEXT
))
11715 if (currentStyle
.HasBulletText())
11717 if (currentStyle
.GetBulletText() != attr
.GetBulletText())
11719 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11720 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_TEXT
);
11721 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_TEXT
);
11726 currentStyle
.SetBulletText(attr
.GetBulletText());
11727 currentStyle
.SetBulletFont(attr
.GetBulletFont());
11731 if (attr
.HasBulletName() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NAME
))
11733 if (currentStyle
.HasBulletName())
11735 if (currentStyle
.GetBulletName() != attr
.GetBulletName())
11737 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11738 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NAME
);
11739 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_BULLET_NAME
);
11744 currentStyle
.SetBulletName(attr
.GetBulletName());
11748 if (attr
.HasURL() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_URL
))
11750 if (currentStyle
.HasURL())
11752 if (currentStyle
.GetURL() != attr
.GetURL())
11754 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11755 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_URL
);
11756 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_URL
);
11761 currentStyle
.SetURL(attr
.GetURL());
11765 if (attr
.HasTextEffects() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECTS
))
11767 if (currentStyle
.HasTextEffects())
11769 // We need to find the bits in the new attr that are different:
11770 // just look at those bits that are specified by the new attr.
11772 // We need to remove the bits and flags that are not common between current attr
11773 // and new attr. In so doing we need to take account of the styles absent from one or more of the
11774 // previous styles.
11776 int currentRelevantTextEffects
= currentStyle
.GetTextEffects() & attr
.GetTextEffectFlags();
11777 int newRelevantTextEffects
= attr
.GetTextEffects() & attr
.GetTextEffectFlags();
11779 if (currentRelevantTextEffects
!= newRelevantTextEffects
)
11781 // Find the text effects that were different, using XOR
11782 int differentEffects
= currentRelevantTextEffects
^ newRelevantTextEffects
;
11784 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11785 clashingAttr
.SetTextEffectFlags(clashingAttr
.GetTextEffectFlags() | differentEffects
);
11786 currentStyle
.SetTextEffectFlags(currentStyle
.GetTextEffectFlags() & ~differentEffects
);
11791 currentStyle
.SetTextEffects(attr
.GetTextEffects());
11792 currentStyle
.SetTextEffectFlags(attr
.GetTextEffectFlags());
11795 // Mask out the flags and values that cannot be common because they were absent in one or more objecrs
11796 // that we've looked at so far
11797 currentStyle
.SetTextEffects(currentStyle
.GetTextEffects() & ~absentAttr
.GetTextEffectFlags());
11798 currentStyle
.SetTextEffectFlags(currentStyle
.GetTextEffectFlags() & ~absentAttr
.GetTextEffectFlags());
11800 if (currentStyle
.GetTextEffectFlags() == 0)
11801 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_EFFECTS
);
11804 if (attr
.HasOutlineLevel() && !wxHasStyle(forbiddenFlags
, wxTEXT_ATTR_OUTLINE_LEVEL
))
11806 if (currentStyle
.HasOutlineLevel())
11808 if (currentStyle
.GetOutlineLevel() != attr
.GetOutlineLevel())
11810 // Clash of attr - mark as such
11811 clashingAttr
.AddFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_OUTLINE_LEVEL
);
11812 currentStyle
.RemoveFlag(wxTEXT_ATTR_OUTLINE_LEVEL
);
11816 currentStyle
.SetOutlineLevel(attr
.GetOutlineLevel());
11820 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxRichTextVariantArray
);
11822 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxRichTextProperties
, wxObject
)
11824 bool wxRichTextProperties::operator==(const wxRichTextProperties
& props
) const
11826 if (m_properties
.GetCount() != props
.GetCount())
11830 for (i
= 0; i
< m_properties
.GetCount(); i
++)
11832 const wxVariant
& var1
= m_properties
[i
];
11833 int idx
= props
.Find(var1
.GetName());
11836 const wxVariant
& var2
= props
.m_properties
[idx
];
11837 if (!(var1
== var2
))
11844 wxArrayString
wxRichTextProperties::GetPropertyNames() const
11848 for (i
= 0; i
< m_properties
.GetCount(); i
++)
11850 arr
.Add(m_properties
[i
].GetName());
11855 int wxRichTextProperties::Find(const wxString
& name
) const
11858 for (i
= 0; i
< m_properties
.GetCount(); i
++)
11860 if (m_properties
[i
].GetName() == name
)
11866 wxVariant
* wxRichTextProperties::FindOrCreateProperty(const wxString
& name
)
11868 int idx
= Find(name
);
11869 if (idx
== wxNOT_FOUND
)
11870 SetProperty(name
, wxString());
11872 if (idx
!= wxNOT_FOUND
)
11874 return & (*this)[idx
];
11880 const wxVariant
& wxRichTextProperties::GetProperty(const wxString
& name
) const
11882 static const wxVariant nullVariant
;
11883 int idx
= Find(name
);
11885 return m_properties
[idx
];
11887 return nullVariant
;
11890 wxString
wxRichTextProperties::GetPropertyString(const wxString
& name
) const
11892 return GetProperty(name
).GetString();
11895 long wxRichTextProperties::GetPropertyLong(const wxString
& name
) const
11897 return GetProperty(name
).GetLong();
11900 bool wxRichTextProperties::GetPropertyBool(const wxString
& name
) const
11902 return GetProperty(name
).GetBool();
11905 double wxRichTextProperties::GetPropertyDouble(const wxString
& name
) const
11907 return GetProperty(name
).GetDouble();
11910 void wxRichTextProperties::SetProperty(const wxVariant
& variant
)
11912 wxASSERT(!variant
.GetName().IsEmpty());
11914 int idx
= Find(variant
.GetName());
11917 m_properties
.Add(variant
);
11919 m_properties
[idx
] = variant
;
11922 void wxRichTextProperties::SetProperty(const wxString
& name
, const wxVariant
& variant
)
11924 int idx
= Find(name
);
11925 wxVariant
var(variant
);
11929 m_properties
.Add(var
);
11931 m_properties
[idx
] = var
;
11934 void wxRichTextProperties::SetProperty(const wxString
& name
, const wxString
& value
)
11936 SetProperty(name
, wxVariant(value
, name
));
11939 void wxRichTextProperties::SetProperty(const wxString
& name
, long value
)
11941 SetProperty(name
, wxVariant(value
, name
));
11944 void wxRichTextProperties::SetProperty(const wxString
& name
, double value
)
11946 SetProperty(name
, wxVariant(value
, name
));
11949 void wxRichTextProperties::SetProperty(const wxString
& name
, bool value
)
11951 SetProperty(name
, wxVariant(value
, name
));
11954 wxRichTextObject
* wxRichTextObjectAddress::GetObject(wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* topLevelContainer
) const
11956 if (m_address
.GetCount() == 0)
11957 return topLevelContainer
;
11959 wxRichTextCompositeObject
* p
= topLevelContainer
;
11961 while (p
&& i
< m_address
.GetCount())
11963 int pos
= m_address
[i
];
11964 wxASSERT(pos
>= 0 && pos
< (int) p
->GetChildren().GetCount());
11965 if (pos
< 0 || pos
>= (int) p
->GetChildren().GetCount())
11968 wxRichTextObject
* p1
= p
->GetChild(pos
);
11969 if (i
== (m_address
.GetCount()-1))
11972 p
= wxDynamicCast(p1
, wxRichTextCompositeObject
);
11978 bool wxRichTextObjectAddress::Create(wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* topLevelContainer
, wxRichTextObject
* obj
)
11982 if (topLevelContainer
== obj
)
11985 wxRichTextObject
* o
= obj
;
11988 wxRichTextCompositeObject
* p
= wxDynamicCast(o
->GetParent(), wxRichTextCompositeObject
);
11992 int pos
= p
->GetChildren().IndexOf(o
);
11996 m_address
.Insert(pos
, 0);
11998 if (p
== topLevelContainer
)
12007 bool wxRichTextSelection::operator==(const wxRichTextSelection
& sel
) const
12009 if (m_container
!= sel
.m_container
)
12011 if (m_ranges
.GetCount() != sel
.m_ranges
.GetCount())
12014 for (i
= 0; i
< m_ranges
.GetCount(); i
++)
12015 if (!(m_ranges
[i
] == sel
.m_ranges
[i
]))
12020 // Get the selections appropriate to the specified object, if any; returns wxRICHTEXT_NO_SELECTION if none
12021 // or none at the level of the object's container.
12022 wxRichTextRangeArray
wxRichTextSelection::GetSelectionForObject(wxRichTextObject
* obj
) const
12026 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* container
= obj
->GetParentContainer();
12028 if (container
== m_container
)
12031 container
= obj
->GetContainer();
12034 if (container
->GetParent())
12036 // If we found that our object's container is within the range of
12037 // a selection higher up, then assume the whole original object
12038 // is also selected.
12039 wxRichTextParagraphLayoutBox
* parentContainer
= container
->GetParentContainer();
12040 if (parentContainer
== m_container
)
12042 if (WithinSelection(container
->GetRange().GetStart(), m_ranges
))
12044 wxRichTextRangeArray ranges
;
12045 ranges
.Add(obj
->GetRange());
12050 container
= parentContainer
;
12059 return wxRichTextRangeArray();
12062 // Is the given position within the selection?
12063 bool wxRichTextSelection::WithinSelection(long pos
, wxRichTextObject
* obj
) const
12069 wxRichTextRangeArray selectionRanges
= GetSelectionForObject(obj
);
12070 return WithinSelection(pos
, selectionRanges
);
12074 // Is the given position within the selection range?
12075 bool wxRichTextSelection::WithinSelection(long pos
, const wxRichTextRangeArray
& ranges
)
12078 for (i
= 0; i
< ranges
.GetCount(); i
++)
12080 const wxRichTextRange
& range
= ranges
[i
];
12081 if (pos
>= range
.GetStart() && pos
<= range
.GetEnd())
12087 // Is the given range completely within the selection range?
12088 bool wxRichTextSelection::WithinSelection(const wxRichTextRange
& range
, const wxRichTextRangeArray
& ranges
)
12091 for (i
= 0; i
< ranges
.GetCount(); i
++)
12093 const wxRichTextRange
& eachRange
= ranges
[i
];
12094 if (range
.IsWithin(eachRange
))